Panasonic WJ HD309 User Manual

Digital Disk Recorders  
Operating Instructions  
WJ-HD309  
Model Nos.  
WJ-HD316  
M
ONITO  
R1  
TIMER  
MONITOR2  
ALARM  
ERROR  
1
5
9
STOP  
2
6
PLAY  
3
SHIFT  
PAUSE  
ALARM  
4
8
REC-  
-
REC STOP  
SUSPEND  
SEQ  
ALARM  
RESET  
PAN/  
TILT  
OSD  
GOTO  
LAST  
7
REV  
SEARCH  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
PULL  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
COPY  
FWD  
TEXT  
A-B  
REPEAT  
OPERATE  
MARK  
SETUP  
/ESC  
HDD  
1
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
IRIS  
HDD  
2
LISTED  
LOGOUT  
13  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
16  
BUSY  
SET  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD  
316  
Before attempting to connect or operate this product,  
please read these instructions carefully and save this manual for future use.  
CONTENTS  
PREFACE .................................................................... 4  
OPERATION OF THE UNIT IN THE CASCADE  
FEATURES .................................................................. 4  
PRECAUTIONS ........................................................... 5  
TRADEMARKS AND REGISTERED  
TRADEMARKS ............................................................ 6  
ABOUT THESE OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS ......... 6  
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY ......................................... 6  
MAJOR OPERATING CONTROLS AND  
THEIR FUNCTIONS .................................................... 7  
I Front View ............................................................. 7  
I Rear View ............................................................. 9  
I On Monitor 1 (To display only live image) ............. 10  
I On Monitor 2  
(To display live or recorded image) ....................... 11  
STARTUP .................................................................... 16  
CLOCK ADJUSTMENT ............................................... 17  
SHUTDOWN ................................................................ 18  
RECORDING (Manual Recording) .............................. 19  
RECORDING (Emergency Recording) ........................ 21  
PLAYBACK .................................................................. 22  
PLAYBACK IMAGE ON A DESIGNATED DISK .......... 25  
PLAYBACK FROM A DESIGNATED  
CONNECTION ............................................................. 63  
I Features ................................................................ 63  
I Operation using the buttons on the front panel ..... 63  
I Operation using a system controller ..................... 63  
INSTALLATION IN THE RACK ................................... 64  
MANAGEMENT OF USERS/HOSTS .......................... 65  
OPERATING THE UNIT FOR THE FIRST TIME ........ 67  
Preparation for maintenance (HDD replacement,  
installation, etc.) ........................................................... 68  
CONNECTIONS .......................................................... 70  
I Connections when the unit is used  
independently ........................................................ 70  
I Connections with an extension unit ...................... 71  
I Connections with DVD-RAM, CD-R, and  
DVD-R drives ........................................................ 72  
I Connections with the VTR .................................... 73  
I Connections with PS·Data systems ...................... 74  
I Cascade connection of multiple units ................... 76  
I Connection with the RS485 camera ..................... 80  
I Mode Switch ......................................................... 82  
I RS485 Port ........................................................... 82  
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM/  
TIME AND DATE ......................................................... 27  
SEARCH AND PLAY ................................................... 28  
I Search for a Recording Event and Play it back  
CONTROL Connector ........................................... 83  
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM  
(Recording Event Search) ..................................... 28  
I Search for a motion detected time and date from  
recorded images and play it (VMD search) ........... 32  
I To delete the motion detection area ..................... 36  
I Search for a marked point and play from that point  
(Marking search) ................................................... 37  
MONITOR LIVE IMAGES ............................................ 38  
I Displaying Live Images on a Single Screen .......... 38  
I Electronic Zoom .................................................... 38  
I Displaying on a Multi-screen ................................. 39  
I Sequential Display ................................................ 40  
CONTROL CAMERAS ................................................ 41  
I Panning/Tilting ...................................................... 41  
I Zoom ..................................................................... 41  
I Focus .................................................................... 41  
I Iris ......................................................................... 42  
I Preset Action ......................................................... 42  
I Move a camera to the preset position ................... 43  
I Auto Function (Auto Pan, etc) ............................... 44  
ABOUT THE EVENT FUNCTION ................................ 45  
I Action at an event occurrence .............................. 45  
I Alarm Function ...................................................... 46  
I Cancel the Alarm Action ....................................... 47  
I Suspend the Alarm Actions ................................... 47  
COPYING (Duplicate) .................................................. 48  
DELETE DATA ON THE DISK .................................... 50  
I Deletion of recorded images saved on the  
Connector ............................................................. 87  
I How to Use the SERIAL Connector ...................... 89  
SETUP ......................................................................... 90  
I Item list of the SETUP MENU ............................... 90  
I About the SETUP MENU ...................................... 92  
I Basic Operation with the SETUP MENU .............. 93  
I [Maintenance] Functions for Maintaining .............. 94  
I [Recording] ............................................................ 98  
I [Event] Function for Events ................................. 100  
I [Schedule] Settings for the recording/  
event action schedule ......................................... 105  
I [Switcher] Settings for the switcher function ....... 110  
I [Display] .............................................................. 113  
I [Comm] Settings for communication with other  
devices ................................................................ 116  
I [System] Settings on System .............................. 121  
DISPLAY SETUP MENU OF CAMERA ..................... 127  
DISK MANAGEMENT ................................................ 128  
I Notes on hard disk .............................................. 128  
I How to replace the built-in hard disk ................... 128  
I About the HDD DISK MENU ............................... 131  
I Display of the HDD DISK MENU ........................ 131  
I RAID 5 Function of the Extension Unit ............... 132  
I Formatting (Initialization) the Hard Disk .............. 133  
I Setting for Mirroring ............................................ 137  
SERIAL (RS232C) CONNECTOR COMMAND  
REFERENCE ............................................................. 141  
I SERIAL (RS232C) Communication Protocol ...... 141  
I Command Format ............................................... 141  
FLOWCHART OF THE SETUP MENU ...................... 151  
PARAMETERS AND THE DEFAULT SETTINGS  
OF THE SETUP MENU ............................................. 152  
TROUBLESHOOTING ............................................... 158  
SPECIFICATION ....................................................... 162  
STANDARD ACCESSORIES .................................... 163  
hard disk manually ................................................ 50  
FORMAT (INITIALIZE) A DVD-RAM DISK .................. 52  
DISPLAY/EDIT TEXT INFORMATION ........................ 54  
ERROR/WARNINGS ................................................... 56  
OPERATION USING A SYSTEM CONTROLLER ...... 58  
OPERATION USING A PC .......................................... 62  
I Features ................................................................ 62  
I System Requirements of a PC ...............................62  
3
PREFACE  
The Digital Disk Recorders WJ-HD316/309 are designed for  
use within a surveillance system and are a combination of a  
hard disk recorder and a video multiplexer (16-input for the  
WJ-HD316, 9-input for the WJ-HD309).  
The digital hard disk recorder is a recording device using a  
hard disk drive to record camera pictures instead of using  
videotapes so that pictures recorded by repeated overwrit-  
ing will not experience deterioration of the recorded picture  
quality. Up to 16 cameras can be connected to the WJ-  
HD316 directly (up to 9 cameras to the WJ-HD309) and it is  
possible to record their camera pictures. It is also possible  
to display four or more camera pictures on a single monitor,  
to switch camera pictures, and to operate cameras using  
this unit.  
FEATURES  
Various Recording Functions  
Remote Operation via Network  
• Multi-Recording  
It is possible to operate this unit using a PC connected to a  
LAN (Local Area Network) or the Internet with the featured  
network function.  
It is possible to perform multiple recordings using a sin-  
gle digital disk recorder even if the operating environ-  
ments are different, for example, recording pictures of  
cameras in different places at different times.  
Security Function and Reliability  
• Schedule recording  
• Authentication function (registration of ID and pass-  
word) allows users access to a predetermined selection  
of the available functions. Up to 32 users can be regis-  
tered.  
It is possible to perform recording automatically at a  
scheduled time on a designated day of the week.  
Schedules can be set on each camera.  
• Emergency Recording  
• If alteration of a recorded image data is made for any  
reason, the alteration alert function will announce it.  
In the case of an emergency, emergency recordings  
will be given a higher priority than other recording  
modes by operating an external switch.  
• If a hard disk crashes, the backup function*1, the mirror-  
ing function*2 and the RAID 5 function*3 prevent any  
data loss.  
• External Timer Recording  
It is possible to perform recording automatically using  
an external timer.  
*1: Only when the recommended DVD-RAM drive, DVD-R  
drive or CD-R drive is used  
*2: The mirroring function does not work with an external  
hard disk drive such as an extension unit.  
*3: To use the RAID 5 function, an optional extension unit is  
required.  
• Event Recording  
At an event occurrence, such as when an alarm signal  
is supplied, the recording mode (quality and recording  
rate) can be changed to high quality to record pictures.  
• Motion Detection Function (VMD)  
It is possible to start recording automatically when  
motion is detected in a shooting area.  
Transmission with Coaxial Cable, PS·Data and  
RS485 Compatible  
• It is possible to control a Panasonic combination cam-  
era such as the WV-CS850 using only a coaxial cable  
but not other devices. Using a coaxial cable also com-  
pensates for transmission loss.  
• It is easy to establish the surveillance system by con-  
necting a PS·Data compatible system controller and  
peripherals.  
Frame Switcher Function  
• It is possible to display pictures of four or more cam-  
eras on a single monitor (multi-screen) splitting the  
monitor screen into 4, 7, 9, 10, 13, or 16 sections using  
the WJ-HD316, and into 4, 7, or 9 sections using the  
WJ-HD309.  
While monitoring a multi-screen, each camera picture  
will be displayed as a moving image.  
4
PRECAUTIONS  
• Refer all work related to the installation of these  
products to qualified service personnel or system  
installers.  
• Built-in hard disk drives  
Hard disk drives are vulnerable to vibration. Handle  
them with care.  
It is possible to damage them if they are moved while  
their motors are still running. Do not move them just  
after turning their power on or off (for around 30 sec-  
onds).  
Hard disk drives are perishable. They will need to be  
replaced after around 20 000 - 30 000 hours of opera-  
tion in case they are used at temperature of 25°C  
(77°F).  
Replacement costs of the hard disk drives are not cov-  
ered by the warranty even if it needs to be done within  
the warranty period. Consult your dealer for servicing.  
When hard disk drive trouble occurs, replace it immedi-  
ately. Consult your dealer for servicing.  
• Do not operate the appliances beyond their speci-  
fied temperature, humidity, or power source ratings.  
Use the appliance at temperatures within +5°C -  
+45°C (41°F - 113°F) and humidity below 85 %.  
The input power source for this appliance is 220 V -  
240 V AC 50 Hz.  
Performance and lifetime of hard disk drives are easily  
affected by heat (used at high temperature) character-  
istically. It is recommended to use this appliance at  
temperatures within +20 °C - +30 °C (68 °F - 86 °F).  
• Handle the appliance with care.  
Do not strike or shake, as this may damage the appli-  
ance.  
When replacing the hard disk drives, take notice of the  
following.  
Do not detach the hard disk drives or the cables con-  
necting the unit and the front cover while the  
HDD1/HDD2 indicators are lit or for around 30 seconds  
after the indicators go off.  
• Do not strike or give a strong shock to the unit.  
It may cause damage or allow water to enter the unit.  
• Built-in backup battery  
Protect the hard disk drives from static electricity.  
Do not stack them, or keep them upright.  
Do not use an electric screwdriver to fix them.  
(Tightening torque: Approx. 0.49 N · m (5 kgf · cm))  
Avoid rapid changes of the temperature/humidity to  
prevent condensation. (Acceptable change: within  
15°C/h (59°F/h))  
Before the first use, charge the built-in backup battery  
(lithium battery) by turning on the power for 48 hours or  
more.  
If it is not charged enough, in a case where the power  
goes down, the internal clock may keep bad time or the  
operative condition may be different to that before the  
electric power failure.  
The built-in battery life is approximately 5 years as an  
indication of replacement. (This is just an indication of  
replacement. We are not providing any guarantee of the  
built-in battery lifetime. Replacement cost of the built-in  
battery is not covered by the warranty even if it needs  
to be done within the warranty period.) Ask the shop  
where you purchased the unit when replacement of the  
battery is required.  
• Avoid placing receptacles that contain liquids such as  
water near the unit.  
If liquid spills onto the unit, it may cause fire or an elec-  
tric shock.  
• Do not expose the unit to water or moisture, or try to  
operate it in wet areas.  
• Prevent condensation from forming on the surface of  
the hard disk.  
• Cooling Fan  
Turn the power off when cleaning the unit. Otherwise it  
may cause injuries.  
Replacement costs of the cooling fan are not covered  
by the warranty even if it needs to be done within the  
warranty period. Consult your dealer for servicing.  
If this happens, do not turn on the power of the recorder  
and leave the recorder for around 2 hours.  
Wait until the dew evaporates in any of the following  
cases:  
• The recorder is placed in an extremely humid place.  
• The recorder is placed in a room where a heater has  
just been turned on.  
• Cleaning  
Turn the power off when cleaning the unit. Otherwise it  
may cause injuries.  
Do not use strong or abrasive detergents when clean-  
ing the appliance body.  
Use a dry cloth to clean the appliance when it is dirty.  
When the dirt is hard to remove, use a mild detergent  
and wipe gently.  
• The recorder is moved from an air-conditioned room  
to a humid and high-temperature room.  
• We recommend that you make a note of your settings  
and save them. This will help when you are required to  
change the system configuration, or when unexpected  
trouble or failure occurs.  
• Indication label  
• Distributing, copying, disassembling, reverse compil-  
ing, reverse engineering, and also exporting in violation  
of export laws of the software provided with this prod-  
uct, is expressly prohibited.  
Refer to the indication labels placed on the top and but-  
tom of the unit as to the indications of equipment classi-  
fication and power source, etc.  
5
TRADEMARKS AND REGISTERED TRADEMARKS  
• Adobe, Adobe logos, and Acrobat are registered trade-  
marks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the U.S. and/  
or other countries.  
• Microsoft, Windows and Windows XP are registered  
trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or  
other countries.  
• Other names of companies and products contained in  
these operating instructions may be trademarks or reg-  
istered trademarks of their respective owners.  
ABOUT THESE OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS  
There are 3 sets of operating instructions for the WJ-  
HD316/WJ-HD309 as follows.  
• Operating Instructions (book, these operating instruc-  
tions)  
• Network Operating Instructions (PDF)  
• Network Setup Instructions (PDF)  
Refer to the "Network Setup Instructions" on the provided  
CD-ROM for descriptions of how to perform the required  
settings and how to connect to other devices.  
Adobe® Reader is required to read these operating instruc-  
tions (PDF) on the provided CD-ROM. When the Adobe®  
Reader is not installed on the PC, download the latest  
Adobe® Reader from the Adobe web site and install it.  
These "Operating Instructions" contain descriptions of how  
to operate this unit with the buttons on the front panel.  
Refer to the "Network Operating Instructions" on the provid-  
ed CD-ROM for descriptions of how to operate this unit  
from a PC.  
"WJ-HD300" or "HD300" shown in the illustrations used in  
these operating instructions indicate this unit or the WJ-  
HD300 series.  
LIMITATION OF LIABILITY  
IN NO EVENT SHALL MATSUSHITA ELECTRIC INDUSTRI-  
AL CO., LTD. BE LIABLE TO ANY PARTY OR ANY PER-  
SON, EXCEPT FOR REPLACEMENT OR REASONABLE  
MAINTENANCE OF THE PRODUCT, FOR THE CASES,  
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO BELOW:  
(2) PERSONAL INJURY OR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY  
INAPPROPRIATE USE OR NEGLIGENT OPERATION  
OF THE USER;  
(3) UNAUTHORIZED DISASSEMBLE, REPAIR OR MODIFI-  
CATION OF THE PRODUCT BY THE USER;  
(4) ANY PROBLEM, CONSEQUENTIAL INCONVENIENCE,  
OR LOSS OR DAMAGE, ARISING OUT OF THE SYS-  
TEM COMBINED BY THE DEVICES OF THIRD PARTY.  
(1) ANY DAMAGE AND LOSS, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIM-  
ITATION, DIRECT OR INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSE-  
QUENTIAL OR EXEMPLARY, ARISING OUT OF OR  
RELATING TO THE PRODUCT;  
6
MAJOR OPERATING CONTROLS AND THEIR FUNCTIONS  
I Front View  
o
! ! @  
! ! ! !  
t
qw er yu i  
!
@
@ @ @  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
PULL  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
TIMER  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
S-VIDEO  
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
ALARM  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
VIDEO  
OUT  
COPY  
2
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
REPEAT  
+
SUSPEND  
ALARM  
RESET  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
[WJ-HD316]  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
AUDIO  
OUT  
HDD  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD  
HDD  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
! !! @  
@
@
@ @  
#
o
! ! @  
! ! ! !  
t
qw er yu i  
!
@
@ @ @  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
PULL  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
TIMER  
1
4
7
2
3
6
9
S-VIDEO  
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
ALARM  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
OSD  
VIDEO  
OUT  
COPY  
2
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
5
8
0
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
REPEAT  
+
SUSPEND  
ALARM  
RESET  
[WJ-HD309]  
COPY  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
AUDIO  
OUT  
HDD  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD  
HDD  
2
SET  
BUSY  
!! @  
@
@
@ @  
#
!
q Operate Indicator (OPERATE)  
Lights up when the power is turned on.  
u HDD Access Indicators (HDD1/HDD2)  
Blinks when the HDD1 or the HDD2 is accessed  
respectively.  
w Alarm Suspension Indicator (ALARM SUSPEND)  
Lights up when the alarm suspension mode is selected.  
i Monitor Switch button (MONITOR1/MONITOR2)  
Pressing this button switches the monitor. This button  
lights up when monitor 1 is selected, and goes off when  
monitor 2 or the VGA monitor is selected.  
e Alarm Indicator (ALARM)  
Blinks when an alarm occurs, and lights steadily when  
the activated alarm is reset automatically.  
To turn this indicator off, press the ALARM RESET but-  
ton.  
o Shift Button (SHIFT)  
Toggles the functions of the camera selection buttons.  
r Alarm Reset Button (ALARM RESET)  
Pressing this button cancels alarm activation, and  
returns the system to the condition before the alarm  
was activated.  
! Camera Selection Buttons ([1] - [10/0], [11] - [16] for  
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309)  
Pressing a button displays live or playback images of  
the selected camera. The LED in the button indicates  
the status as follows.  
t Error indicator (ERROR)  
Green: When a button is lit green, the currently dis-  
played image on the monitor is live from the respec-  
tive camera.  
Blinks orange when an error occurs that will not keep  
the unit from running.  
Blinks red when an error occurs that may cause the  
system to go down.  
Orange: When a button is lit orange, the image from the  
respective camera is recorded.  
Refer to page 56 for further information about error/  
warnings.  
Blue: When a button is lit blue, the currently displayed  
image on the monitor is live from the respective  
camera and is also recorded.  
y Timer Indicator (TIMER)  
Lights up when the schedule recording is set, and  
blinks while the schedule recording is being performed.  
7
When the shift button is lit, these buttons work as the  
toggled function buttons.  
(The buttons available as the toggled function buttons  
will light green when the shift button is lit.)  
@ Set Button (SET)  
Works differently depending on the situations listed  
below:  
• Plays recorded images at the current playback speed  
when this button is pressed during fast playback.  
• Registers preset positions of cameras.  
• Activates the auto focus function.  
• Sets the alarm suspension mode on/off.  
• Determines the setting of parameters on the setup  
menus.  
! Pan, Tilt, Latest Recorded Image Playback Button  
(PAN/TILT, GO TO LAST)  
Pans/tilts the selected camera, or plays back the latest  
recorded image.  
(Refer to pages 41 and 23 respectively.)  
! Zoom, Focus, A - B Repeat Button (ZOOM/FOCUS,  
A-B REPEAT)  
@ Jog Dial  
Works differently depending on the situations as fol-  
lows:  
• Plays recorded images frame by frame when this dial is  
rotated during pausing playback.  
Zooms in/out, adjusts focus, or repeats playback of  
recorded images between two designated points.  
(Refer to pages 41 and 24 respectively.)  
• Skips playback time when this dial is rotated during  
playback at normal speed.  
! Iris, Listing Button (IRIS, LISTED)  
Adjusts iris, or enables/disables the filtering playback.  
(Refer to pages 42 and 28 respectively.)  
• Moves the cursor on the search menu or the thumbnail  
menu.  
• Selects a parameter setting or a character on the setup  
menus.  
! Preset, Auto Function Button (PRESET/AUTO)  
Moves a camera to the preset position, or activates the  
auto function of the camera.  
@ Shuttle Ring  
(Refer to pages 42 and 44 respectively.)  
Works differently depending on the situations as fol-  
lows:  
! Stop Button (STOP)  
• Plays fast when this dial is rotated during playback at  
Stops playback.  
normal speed.  
• Turns the search menu pages or the thumbnail menu  
pages.  
! Play/Pause Button (PLAY/PAUSE)  
Plays recorded images, or pauses playback.  
@ Connectors Cover  
! Record Button (REC/REC STOP)  
Starts recording. To stop recording, press this button  
down for 2 seconds or more.  
@ Copy Port (COPY2)  
Connect a recommended external recording device to  
this port.  
! Slow Button (SLOW)  
Pans/tilts the selected camera slowly.  
@ S-Video Output Connector (S-VIDEO)  
Connect the S-video input connector of a VTR with this  
connector. The same video signal supplied to the MON-  
ITOR OUT2 connector on the rear panel will be sup-  
plied to this connector.  
! Search Button (SEARCH)  
Displays the search menu.  
@ Setup, Escape Button (SETUP/ESC)  
Displays the setup menu, or turns back to the previous  
page of the setup menu, etc.  
@ Video Output Connector (VIDEO OUT)  
Connect the video input connector of a VTR with this  
connector. The same video signal supplied to the MON-  
ITOR OUT2 connector on the rear panel will be sup-  
plied to this connector.  
@ Busy Indicator (BUSY)  
Lights when the selected camera was not available to  
operate because another user is operating it using a  
controller or a PC via a network. In this case, wait until  
this indicator goes off.  
# Audio Output Connector (AUDIO OUT)  
This connector, for an RCA standard jack, supplies an  
unbalanced –10 dBV, 600 line output audio signal to  
an external device.  
@ Arrow Buttons (CDAB)  
Adjusts zooming/focus, or moves the cursor on the  
setup menus and the search menu.  
Recorded audio will be supplied from this connector  
during playback.  
The same audio signal supplied to the AUDIO OUT  
connector on the rear panel will be supplied to this con-  
nector.  
8
I Rear View  
o !  
!
!
!
!
q w  
t y ui  
e
! !  
!
!
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
2
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
15  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
[WJ-HD316]  
16  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
10  
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
r
!
!
o !  
!
!
!
q w  
t y ui  
e
! !  
!
!
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
MODE  
2
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
2
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
IN  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
9
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
[WJ-HD309]  
OUT  
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
r
!
q Audio Input Connectors (AUDIO IN 1 - 4)  
t Monitor Output Connector (MONITOR OUT1, MONI-  
TOR OUT2/CASCADE OUT)  
These connectors, for RCA pin jacks, accept an unbal-  
anced –10 dBV, 10 kline input audio signal supplied  
from an external device such as a microphone amplifi-  
er.  
Connect monitors to these BNC connectors.  
The MONITOR OUT2 connector can also be used as  
the CASCADE OUT connector.  
When using two or more units of the WJ-HD316/WJ-  
HD309 and using the MONITOR OUT2 connector as  
the CASCADE OUT connector, connect with the CAS-  
CADE IN connector of another WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309.  
w Audio Output Connector (AUDIO OUT)  
This connector, for an RCA standard jack, supplies an  
unbalanced –10 dBV, 600 line output audio signal to  
an external device.  
Recorded audio will be supplied from this connector  
during playback.  
y Cascade In Connector (CASCADE IN)  
Connect with the CASCADE OUT connector of another  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309 when using two or more units of  
the WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309.  
e Video Input Connectors (CAMERA IN 1 - 16 for the  
WJ-HD316/CAMERA IN 1 - 9 for the WJ-HD309)  
Connect system cameras or combination cameras to  
these BNC connectors.  
u Serial Connector (SERIAL)  
Connect a PC with this D-Sub 9-pin connector when  
controlling this unit.  
A 75 termination is made unless the video output ter-  
minal is connected.  
To connect combination cameras, connect them to the  
CAMERA IN 1 - 8 connectors of the WJ-HD316, or the  
CAMERA IN 1 - 6 of the WJ-HD309 (accept coaxial  
communication).  
i Monitor Connector (MONITOR (VGA))  
Connect a VGA monitor with this connector. The same  
video signal supplied to the MONITOR OUT2 connector  
will be supplied to this connector.  
r Video Output Connectors (CAMERA OUT 1 - 16 for  
the WJ-HD316/CAMERA OUT 1 - 9 for the WJ-HD309)  
These BNC connectors supply video signals looped  
through the video input connectors.  
IMPORTANT  
For European Customers  
The refresh rate of the video output signal supplied from the  
MONITOR (VGA) connector is 50 Hz. Some VGA monitors  
in Europe may not support this refresh rate and could be  
damaged. Please check the refresh rate supported by your  
VGA monitor before connecting.  
Note: Video signals will not be supplied from the CAM-  
ERA OUT 1 - 8 connectors (CAMERA OUT 1 - 6  
connectors for the WJ-HD309) if the power of the  
unit is off.  
9
Please check the documentation supplied with your monitor  
to see if your VGA monitor supports a refresh rate of 50 Hz.  
If your VGA monitor does not support 50 Hz (or if you are  
not sure), then turn off your VGA monitor before turning on  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309 when using your television as a dis-  
play.  
I On Monitor 1 (To display only  
live image)  
q
q
we  
we  
o Alarm Connector (ALARM)  
Connect an external device such as a sensor or a door  
switch with this D-Sub 25-pin connector.  
q
! Alarm/Control Connector (ALARM/CONTROL)  
Connect a control switch with this D-Sub 25-pin con-  
nector when controlling this unit using an external  
device, or when controlling an alarm device such as a  
buzzer or a lamp.  
q
q
we  
we  
The negative circled numbers indicate the default positions  
of camera title q, time w and event display e.  
! PS·Data Ports (DATA)  
Connect PS·Data compatible devices with these ports.  
Important:  
! Mode Switches (MODE)  
• The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and  
the VGA monitor. (It is impossible to display the SETUP  
MENU on monitor 1.)  
Set the operation mode of this unit with these dip  
switches.  
• It will take around 2 minutes to display live images on  
monitor 1 after turning on the power of the unit.  
! RS485 Ports (RS485 (CAMERA))  
Connect RS485 compatible combination cameras with  
these ports.  
1. Camera Title  
Displays the edited camera title.  
A position to display the camera title can be selected  
from the following.  
Upper left, upper right, lower left, lower right, centre  
The default camera title position is lower right (R-  
LOWER).  
! Network Port (10/100BASE-T)  
Connect this unit to a network compatible with 10BASE-  
T or 100BASE-Tx when controlling this unit using a PC  
via a network.  
! Copy Port (COPY1)  
Connect a recommended external recording device to  
this port.  
Note: The camera title will be displayed with 16 charac-  
ters (2 lines: 8 characters per line).  
! Extra Storage Port (EXT STORAGE)  
Connect an optional extension unit (WJ-HDE300 series)  
with this port.  
2. Time  
Displays the current time (hour:minute:second) and  
date (day:month:year).  
A position to display the time can be selected from the  
following.  
Centre, upper left, lower left, upper right, lower right  
The default time display position is upper left (L-  
UPPER).  
! Power Switch (POWER)  
Turns the power of this unit on and off.  
! Signal Ground Terminal (SIGNAL GND)  
! Power Cord Inlet (AC IN)  
Notes:  
Connect the power cord to this inlet.  
• When the camera title and the time display are lay-  
ered, only the time display will be displayed.  
• When monitor 1 is selected, it is possible to turn  
on/off display of the camera title and the time by  
pressing the camera selection button 8 for the WJ-  
HD316 (the camera selection button 6 for the WJ-  
HD309) while the shift function is on (by pressing  
the SHIFT button).  
10  
3. Event Display  
Important:  
When an event has occurred, an event display will be  
displayed.  
• Since the VGA output from this unit is the same as for  
televisions (720 H x 576 V pixels/vertical frequency of  
50 Hz), it may be possible that both the left and right  
edges can not fit onto the screen depending on the  
VGA monitor.  
• It is impossible to use the MONITOR (VGA) connector  
when connecting the unit in the cascade connection.  
• It may take time to display live images on the VGA mon-  
itor if the VGA monitor is turned on/off when the unit is  
running.  
The position of an event display will be symmetrical to  
the position where the time is displayed. When the time  
is displayed at the lower left of the screen, an event dis-  
play will be displayed at the upper right corner of the  
screen. The default position of an event display is the  
upper right corner of the screen (R-UPPER).  
The event display will be displayed differently as follows  
depending on which event has occurred.  
VMD-*: When motion is detected.  
LOSS-*: When video loss has occurred.  
COM-#: When a command alarm has occurred.  
TRM-#: When a terminal alarm has occurred.  
IMPORTANT  
For European Customers  
Some VGA monitors in Europe cannot be used simultane-  
ously with television display. When you enable television  
display in Europe, the refresh rate for the monitor and tele-  
vision is set to 50Hz. Some VGA monitors may not support  
this refresh rate and could be damaged.  
• Please check the documentation supplied with your  
monitor to see if your VGA monitor supports a refresh  
rate of 50 Hz.  
*: Camera number (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9 for  
the WJ-HD309)  
#: Alarm number  
Note: Refer to page 45 for further information about  
event types and event actions.  
If your VGA monitor does not support 50 Hz (or if you  
are not sure), then turn off your VGA monitor before  
turning on WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309 when using your tele-  
vision as a display.  
I On Monitor 2 (To display live or  
recorded images)  
1. Camera Title  
Displays the edited camera title.  
A position to display the camera title can be selected  
from the following.  
Upper left, upper right, lower left, lower right, centre  
The default camera title position is lower right (R-  
LOWER).  
q
q
q
w
w
q
B
C
2. Task Bar  
q
Displays the current status.  
The task bar consists of the main bar (w - A), the left  
bar (w - B), and the right bar (w - C).  
There are 3 different ways to display the task bar as fol-  
lows.  
w A  
The negative circled number q indicates the camera title  
default position.  
Mode 1  
Notes:  
Displays only the main bar and the status is displayed  
on it.  
• The same images displayed on monitor 2 will be dis-  
played on the VGA monitor.  
• The camera title will be displayed with 16 characters (2  
lines: 8 characters per line).  
• When monitor 2 is selected, it is possible to switch the  
way of displaying the camera title in the following order  
by pressing the camera selection button 8 for the WJ-  
HD316 (the camera selection button 6 for the WJ-  
HD309) while the shift function is on (by pressing the  
SHIFT button):  
Display the camera title Display the camera title in  
list form Not display the camera title  
11  
Note: When the camera title and the task bar are lay-  
ered in this mode, only the task bar will be dis-  
played.  
Mode 2  
Displays the status on the main bar, the left bar and the  
right bar.  
Mode 3  
Displays the status only on the main bar, and does not  
display information on the left bar and the right bar.  
Note: Mode 2 and Mode 3 are graphic operated. They  
may not be as clear as Mode 1.  
12  
Status on the Task Bar  
On the Main Bar  
q Status Display Area  
e Live/Playback Time Display Area  
t Error Display Area  
w Copy/Delete Icons  
r Alarm Display Area  
q Status Display Area  
Indicated Item  
Live  
Status  
Indication  
Indicates the live image display status  
: Live image is displayed  
: Live images are displayed  
sequentially  
Playback  
Indicates that playback is currently being performed  
with the displayed playback speed  
5: Currently playing  
4: Currently playing in reverse  
h: Currently pausing  
2
: Currently playing at fast speed  
: Currently playing in reverse at fast  
1
speed  
Recording  
Search  
Indicates that recording is currently being performed  
Indicates that searching is currently being performed  
: Currently recording  
: Currently searching  
w Copy/Delete Icons  
Indicated Item  
Copy  
Status  
Indication  
Indicates that data copy is currently being performed  
: Currently copying  
Delete  
Indicates that data deletion is currently being per-  
formed  
: Currently deleting data  
e Live/Playback Time Display Area  
Indicated Item  
Status  
Indication  
Time  
Displays time and date of the displayed image  
When displaying live image: Current time and  
date  
When playing recorded image: Time and date  
when recorded  
Year:Month:Day  
Hour:Minute:Second  
*: During summer time, an asterisk (*) will be dis-  
played on the left side of the displayed time.  
13  
r Alarm Display Area  
Indicated Item  
Alarm  
Status  
Indication  
Indicates that an alarm has occurred  
VMD-*: When motion is detected  
LOSS-*: When video loss has occurred  
COM-*: When a command alarm has occurred  
TRM-*: When a terminal alarm has occurred  
Alarm type  
*: Camera number (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9 for  
the WJ-HD309)  
#: Alarm number  
Alarm is occurring currently  
Note: Refer to page 45 for further information about event types and event actions.  
t Error Display Area  
Indicated Item  
Status  
Indication  
Error Warning  
Indicates an error occurrence or warning  
ALT-*: Alteration is detected  
W-ERROR: Failed to write data on the HDD  
SMART: Warning of the HDD malfunction  
H-METER: Set time for hour-meter (active time of  
the HDD) warning has passed  
Error type  
THERMAL: The temperature inside the unit is too  
high  
Error is occurring currently  
POWER: A power outage has been detected  
#-nn%: Warning about running out of disk space  
while displaying available disk space per-  
centage  
#-FULL: No available disk space  
MEDIUM-n: An error occurred in an external  
recording device  
REMOVE: The hard disk is removed from the sys-  
tem automatically because of an access error  
FAN: The fan is faulty  
Abbreviation of partition  
Status  
Displayed  
abbreviation  
NML  
EVT  
CPY  
Normal recording area  
Event recording area  
Copy area  
External recording device  
connected to the COPY1 port  
on the rear panel  
External recording device  
connected to the COPY2 port  
on the front panel  
*: Camera number (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9  
for the WJ-HD309)  
#: Abbreviation that indicates partition  
nn: Available disk size  
CP1  
CP2  
n: Number of connector that an external recording  
device is connected to  
Note: Refer to page 56 for further information about error types and what to do when an error has occurred.  
14  
On the Left Bar  
Indicated Item  
Status  
Indication  
Camera  
Indicates recording and displaying status  
Grey: Camera currently not displayed or not con-  
nected to the respective channel  
Green: Camera displayed on the monitor  
Orange: Camera currently being recorded  
Blue: Camera currently being recorded and dis-  
played on the monitor  
Camera 1 is on the top and camera  
16 is on the bottom  
On the Right Bar  
Indicated Item  
Status  
Indication  
Used disk space  
Indicates the available disk space of each partition.  
Top: 100 % of the disk space is being used (no  
available disk space)  
Second from the top: 80 % of the disk space is  
being used  
Centre: 60 % of the disk space is being used  
Second from the bottom: 40 % of the disk space  
is being used  
Normal Recording Area  
Event Recording Area  
Bottom: 20 % of the disk space is being used  
Note: When "CONTINUE" is selected on the "Disk End  
Mode" page of the "Maintenance" setup menu, the  
available disk space will not be displayed. Refer  
to a system administrator for further information.  
NML: Available disk space of the normal record-  
ing area used for manual recording and  
schedule recording  
EVT: Available disk space of the event recording  
area used for event recording and emergency  
recording  
15  
STARTUP  
z Insert the power plug to an outlet (AC 220 V -  
c Enter a user name and password.  
240 V, 50 Hz)  
Note: Make sure the power source is AC 220 V - 240 V,  
50 Hz.  
x Turn on the power switch on the rear panel.  
The OPERATE indicator will light and the system check  
(checking the system and hard disk) will start.  
The startup splash image below will be displayed on moni-  
tor 2 and the VGA monitor during the system check.  
Rotate the jog dial to select a character to be entered in the  
cursor position.  
It is also possible to enter numbers by pressing the camera  
selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9],  
[0] for the WJ-HD309).  
To move the cursor, press the arrow buttons.  
Use the same method to enter or edit characters attached  
to images. Refer to page 54 for further information.  
Notes:  
• The default user name and password are as follows:  
User name: ADMIN  
Password: 12345  
When the auto login is off, the login window will be dis-  
played if any button on the front panel of this unit is pressed  
after the system check. (Go to step 3)  
When the auto login is on, live images will be displayed  
after the system check.  
• To enhance the security, change the password for an  
administrator before starting to run the unit. It is recom-  
mended to change the password for an administrator  
periodically.  
• To log out, press the LOGOUT button after confirming  
that the SHIFT indicator is lit.  
Notes:  
• If the hard disk configuration was changed after the last  
startup or the hard disk has problems, the HDD DISK  
MENU will be displayed automatically after the startup  
splash. (Refer to page 131 for further information.)  
• It is possible to display the disk configuration menu by  
pressing the SET button when the image displayed  
below that says the system check has been completed.  
v Display a live image.  
Press the SET button to display a live image.  
If the authentication (login) window is displayed, enter the  
user name and password.  
When authenticated, a live image will be displayed.  
When not authenticated, the authentication (login) window  
will be displayed again.  
Important:  
When using the optional extension unit (WJ-HDE300  
series), turn on the power of this unit after turning on the  
power of all extension units.  
16  
CLOCK ADJUSTMENT  
It is recommended to check the clock periodically and put  
the clock right if it shows the wrong time.  
Adjust the clock when displaying a live image.  
c Move the cursor to "Time & Date" using the  
arrows button (CD), and press the SET but-  
ton.  
The "Time & Date" menu will be displayed.  
zn  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
LIVE  
REV  
FWD  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
Basic Setup  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Time & Date  
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY  
12H  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
Time  
&
Date  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
.
.
:
REPEAT  
1
JAN  
03  
12 00 00  
AM  
+
SET  
OFF  
12 :00 AM  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
Auto Adjust Time  
Master Time  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)  
IRIS  
I
LISTED  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
AUTO  
I
I
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table  
SETUP  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
BUSY  
xcv cb v  
v Move the cursor to "Time Format" using the  
arrows button and set the time (Day, Month,  
Year, Time) using the jog dial.  
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or  
more.  
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the  
VGA monitor.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
Basic Setup  
LIVE  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Time & Date  
DD.MMM.YY  
12H  
I
I
I
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
Time  
&
Date  
LIVE  
Comm  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
:
:
1
.
JAN  
.
03  
12 00 00  
AM  
SET  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
OFF  
12 :00 AM  
AUTO  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Auto Adjust Time  
Master Time  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)  
I
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
I
I
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table  
SETUP  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
b Move the cursor to "SET" and press the SET  
button.  
x Move the cursor to "System" using the arrows  
The selected date format and the set time will be applied.  
button (CDAB) and press the SET button.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Basic Setup  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Time & Date  
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY  
12H  
Time  
&
Date  
Basic Setup  
ADMIN Password  
*****  
PSD User  
ADMIN  
Auto Login  
Auto Login User  
I
I
I
User Regist.  
User Edit  
Time  
&
Date  
:
:
1
.
JAN  
.
03  
12 00 00  
AM  
SET  
OFF  
12 :00 AM  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
Auto Adjust Time  
Master Time  
I
ON  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
AUTO  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table  
I
I
ADMIN  
Auto Logout  
Priority  
"GO TO LAST" before  
Language  
Beep(Operation)  
Buzzer(Error)  
Shutdown Time  
Auto Copy  
OFF  
SETUP  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
Follow the priority.  
5s  
ENGLISH  
ON  
2s  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
10s  
OFF  
n Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or  
more.  
The SETUP MENU will disappear and a live image will be  
displayed.  
Important:  
Recording will stop for around 4 seconds just after set-  
ting the clock.  
17  
SHUTDOWN  
To shutdown the unit, do the following.  
When recording is being performed, press the REC button  
for 2 or more seconds. Recording will stop and the indica-  
tor on the REC button will go off.  
When playback is being performed, press the STOP button.  
Playback will stop and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE  
button will go off.  
Turn off the power of the unit after confirming that the HDD1  
and HDD2 indicators are off.  
Important:  
• Detach the plug from the outlet if not operating the unit  
for a length of time.  
• When the unit has not been used for a certain period,  
turn on the power of the unit (approximately once a  
week), and perform recording/playback to prevent  
interferences with functions.  
18  
RECORDING (Manual Recording)  
Do the following to record manually.  
Refer to a system administrator about the required settings  
for manual recording.  
When recording with higher priority than manual recording  
is performed, manual recording will not be performed until  
this recording finishes.  
Refer to the following about the recording mode.  
zx  
x Stop recording.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
Press the REC button down for around 2 seconds.  
The indicator on the button will go off and recording will  
stop.  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
Notes:  
• The camera selection button will light orange (currently  
recording) or blue (currently being recorded and dis-  
played on the monitor) to indicate which camera is  
being recorded.  
• When recording with other recording modes being per-  
formed, the indicator on the REC button will not go off  
even though the REC button is pressed to stop manual  
recording.  
z Start recording.  
Press the REC button to start recording.  
The indicator on the button will light and recording will start.  
Images from all the connected cameras will be recorded  
with the default setting.  
It is possible to record only images displayed on monitor 2  
and the VGA monitor by changing the settings.  
Recording Mode and Priority  
There are 4 recording modes as follows.  
Recording Mode  
Emergency Recording  
Event Recording  
Manual Recording  
Schedule Recording  
Description  
Priority*1  
Start recording manually using an external switch at an emergency event occurrence Highest  
Recording will be performed automatically at an event occurrence  
Start and stop recording manually  
1*2  
2*2  
3*2  
Recording will be performed automatically with a designated start/stop time and date  
*1: Priorities on the above table are the default settings. (Emergency recording is the highest priority.)  
*2: Priorities for manual recording, schedule recording and event recording can be changed. Refer to a system administrator  
about the settings.  
19  
Recording Time  
The possible recording durations on the following table are just the average values. (Refer to the important notice below the  
table.)  
Recording rate for a single camera channel (Recording without audio)  
Unit: Hour  
Recording Rate [ips]  
SFA  
19 000  
9 500  
6 300  
4 700  
3 800  
1 900  
1 100  
700  
SFB  
12 700  
6 300  
4 200  
3 100  
2 500  
1 200  
700  
FQA  
25 400  
12 700  
8 400  
6 300  
5 000  
2 500  
1 400  
1 000  
600  
FQB  
19 000  
9 500  
6 300  
4 700  
3 800  
1 900  
1 100  
700  
NQA  
38 100  
19 000  
12 700  
9 500  
7 600  
3 800  
2 200  
1 500  
900  
NQB  
25 400  
12 700  
8 400  
6 300  
5 000  
2 500  
1 400  
1 000  
600  
EXA  
50 800  
25 400  
16 900  
12 700  
10 100  
5 000  
2 900  
2 000  
1 200  
1 000  
800  
EXB  
38 100  
19 000  
12 700  
9 500  
7 600  
3 800  
2 200  
1 500  
900  
0.1  
0.2  
0.3  
0.4  
0.5  
1
1.7  
2.5  
4.2  
5
500  
400  
300  
400  
300  
200  
500  
300  
700  
500  
700  
6.3  
8.3  
12.5  
25  
300  
200  
400  
300  
600  
400  
600  
200  
100  
300  
200  
400  
300  
600  
400  
100  
100  
200  
100  
300  
200  
400  
300  
70  
50  
100  
70  
100  
100  
200  
100  
50  
30  
20  
50  
30  
70  
50  
100  
70  
Important:  
The possible recording durations on the above tables are the average durations under the conditions below. The possible  
recording durations varies depending on images to be recorded. Refer to a system administrator for further information.  
• Recording on the built-in hard disk (160 GB x 1)  
• Recording images from a single camera channel by manual recording  
• Resolution: FIELD  
• Color Mode: COLOR STD (The color mode setting is available only using a PC via a network.)  
• Recording without audio (When recording with audio, disk usage will be at the rate of 79.2 MB per hour.)  
20  
RECORDING (Emergency Recording)  
Record manually using an external switch at an emergency  
event occurrence.  
For example, install an external switch at the reception  
counter, and start recording with it when a suspicious indi-  
vidual appears.  
• When starting emergency recording while another  
recording with a different recording mode (except event  
recording) is being performed, the indicator on the REC  
button will remain lit and the other recording will resume  
after the emergency recording has finished.  
Refer to a system administrator about the required settings  
for emergency recording.  
Recording duration of emergency  
recording  
Recording duration of emergency recording can be set as  
follows. Refer to a system administrator for further informa-  
tion.  
z
Parameter  
Recording Duration  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
TIMER  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
1 s - 10 s  
Record for the selected time (1 - 10 sec-  
onds, can be set in 1 second intervals)  
Record for 20 seconds  
ERROR  
SEARCH  
ALARM  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
REPEAT  
ALARM  
RESET  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
20 s  
30 s  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
HDD 1  
HDD 2  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
LOGOUT  
Record for 30 seconds  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
1 m - 10 m  
Record for the selected time (1 -10 min-  
utes can be set in 1 minute intervals)  
Record for the selected time (20 - 60 min-  
utes, can be set in 10 minutes intervals)  
Record only while the external switch is  
being pressed down  
20 m - 60 m  
MANUAL  
x
z Press the external switch.  
The indicator on the REC button will light and recording will  
start.  
CONTINUE  
Record until the ALARM RESET button is  
pressed  
With the default setting, recording will be performed for 10  
seconds.  
Emergency recording is the highest priority. Emergency  
recording will be performed even when this unit is record-  
ing in other recording modes.  
x Stop recording.  
When the recording duration set in advance has passed,  
recording will stop automatically.  
With the default setting, recording will stop automatically  
after recording for 10 seconds.  
When "CONTINUE" is selected for "Recording Time" of  
"Emergency REC" on the SETUP MENU (Recording), press  
the ALARM RESET button to stop recording.  
The indicator on the REC button will go off and recording  
will stop.  
Important:  
• The camera selection button will light orange (currently  
recording) or blue (currently being recorded and dis-  
played on the monitor) to indicate which camera is  
being recorded.  
21  
PLAYBACK  
It is possible to play recorded images without stopping  
recording.  
The playback images will be displayed on monitor 2 and  
the VGA monitor.  
x Start playback.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will light and the  
recorded images of the selected camera will be played.  
[WJ-HD316]  
First playback after login: The latest recorded image will  
be played.  
z
c x  
With the default setting, playback will start 5 seconds  
before the start time of the latest recorded image. The  
start time can be selected from the following:  
5 s/10 s/30 s/1 m/5 m  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
Refer to a system administrator about the settings.  
Other than those above: Playback will start from the end  
[WJ-HD309]  
point of the recorded image played last time.  
z
c x  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
c Stop playback.  
Press the STOP button.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and  
playback will be stopped.  
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
BUSY  
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor.  
z Select the camera respective to the recorded  
images to be played. (Go to step 2 if not neces-  
sary)  
Press the desired camera selection button.  
The pressed camera selection button will light green or  
blue and the respective live images will be displayed.  
Available functions during playback  
Pause  
Pressing the PLAY/PAUSE button to pause playback. While pausing,  
the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will blink.  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
Pressing this button again will resume playback.  
Single frame skip  
Rotating the jog dial during pause will skip to the next or previous  
frame.  
REV  
FWD  
Rotating the jog dial clockwise will skip to the next frame and rotating  
it counterclockwise will skip to the previous frame.  
+
22  
Fast forward/Fast reverse  
Hold playback speed  
Skip  
Rotating the shuttle ring will change the playback speed (1/2x, 1x, 2x,  
5x, 10x, 20x) according to rotated degree. When the shuttle ring is  
held in the 20x position (rotated to the end) for 5 seconds, the play-  
back speed will be 50x. When the shuttle ring is held 5 more seconds  
after the playback speed became 50x, the playback speed will be  
100x.  
Rotating the shuttle ring clockwise will play images at a faster speed  
and rotating it counterclockwise will play images in reverse at a faster  
speed.  
REV  
FWD  
+
To play at normal speed, release the shuttle ring.  
Press the SET button while holding the rotated shuttle ring to hold a  
desired playback speed. (Playback speed will be held even though  
the shuttle ring is released.)  
REV  
FWD  
+
To return to the normal playback speed, press the SET button.  
+
SET  
Rotating the jog dial during playback will skip to the next or previous  
recorded image.  
REV  
FWD  
Rotating the jog dial clockwise will skip to the start time of the next  
recording and start playback, and rotating it counterclockwise will  
skip to the start time of the previous one. (Rotating the jog dial coun-  
terclockwise at the point around the start time of the recording will  
skip to the start time of two more previous recordings).  
If there is no next or previous recorded image, current playback will  
continue.  
+
Play the latest recorded image  
Multi-screen display  
Press the GO TO LAST button to play the latest recorded image.  
PAN/  
GOTO  
LAST  
TILT  
It is possible to display recorded images in multi-screen format  
(4/7/9/10/13/16 for the WJ-HD316, 4/7/9 for the WJ-HD309).  
q Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will light.  
w Press a camera selection button (1 - 6 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 3 for  
the WJ-HD309) to select a desired multi-screen.  
Camera selection button 1: 4-split screen  
Camera selection button 2: 7-split screen  
Camera selection button 3: 9-split screen  
Camera selection button 4: 16-split screen (Only for the WJ-  
HD316)  
SHIFT  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
+
+
1
6
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
(For the WJ-HD309)  
+
+
1
3
Camera selection button 5: 10-split screen (Only for the WJ-  
HD316)  
Camera selection button 6: 13-split screen (Only for the WJ-  
HD316)  
e To display recorded images on a single screen, press the SHIFT  
button again.  
After the SHIFT indicator goes off, press the camera selection but-  
ton.  
23  
Marking  
It is possible to play from a marked point. Do the following to mark a  
desired point.  
Mark  
Mark  
1. Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will light.  
2. Press the camera selection button 12 (9 for the WJ-HD309) (MARK)  
at a desired point to be marked during playback.  
Up to 100 points can be marked. When more than 100 points are  
marked, the older marked points will be overwritten by the newer  
marked points. In this case, the oldest marked point is the first to  
be overwritten.  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
+
+
12  
9
(For the WJ-HD309)  
When marked while displaying in multi-screen, the same number of  
split screens will be counted as marked points. (When a point is  
marked while displaying a 16-split screen, 16 points will be marked  
simultaneously.)  
Text display  
It is possible to display text information attached to a recorded image  
during playback.  
Text display is available only when playing on a single screen.  
q Pause playback.  
w Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will light.  
e Press the camera selection button 11 (5 for the WJ-HD309) (TEXT).  
TEXT  
TEXT  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
+
+
11  
5
(For the WJ-HD309)  
A - B repeat playback  
It is possible to play recorded images between two designated points  
repeatedly.  
q Designate a start point (A) by pressing the A - B REPEAT button  
during playback.  
A-B  
REPEAT  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
The A - B REPEAT indicator will light, and the time of point A will  
be displayed.  
Blink: During the A-B repeat playback  
Light: When designating a start point (A)  
Time of point A  
To cancel the designated point, press the SETUP/ESC button.  
w Designate an end point (B) by pressing the A - B REPEAT button  
during playback.  
When the start point and the end point are set, the A - B REPEAT  
indicator will start blinking.  
Playback between point A and B will start and keep playing  
repeatedly.  
The time of point A and B will be displayed during playback.  
Time of point A and B  
e Press the A - B REPEAT button during A - B repeat playback to  
return to normal playback.  
Notes:  
• Playback will be paused if the playback time caught up with the recording time (present time) when recording and play-  
back are performed simultaneously.  
• When playing images recorded at a high recording rate, unsteady playback speed and audio break-up may occur.  
24  
PLAYBACK IMAGE ON A DESIGNATED DISK  
Images from a camera will be recorded on the built-in hard  
disk or external recording devices (DVD-RAM drive, DVD-R  
[WJ-HD316]  
drive or CD-R drive) connected to this unit.  
Available disk areas are as follows.  
Note: External recording devices can be used as a copy  
area for images recorded on the hard disk. It is impos-  
sible to record images on the external recording  
devices directly.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
HDD Normal Recording Area/Event Recording Area:  
Disk space for recording on the built-in hard disk  
Recorded images by manual recording (refer to page  
19) or event recording will be stored in this area.  
z
x
[WJ-HD309]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
HDD Copy Area: Disk space for recording on the built-in  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
hard disk  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
Recorded images will be copied in this area (refer to  
page 48).  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
BUSY  
Built-in hard disk  
z
x
Recording area for  
manual recording and  
normal schedule  
z Press the SHIFT button.  
The SHIFT indicator will light.  
recording  
Normal recording area  
x Press the camera selection button 9 (7 for the  
Recording area for  
event recording and  
WJ-HD309) (DISK SELECT).  
emergency recording  
The DISK SELECT window will be displayed on monitor 2  
and the VGA monitor.  
Event recording area  
Recording area for  
copying  
DISK SELECT  
Copy area  
HDD NORMAL/EVENT AREA  
HDD COPY AREA  
OK  
CANCEL  
Notes:  
• Playback images will be displayed only on monitor 2  
and the VGA monitor.  
• Playback can be performed during recording.  
• When a pre-recording area is created in an optional  
extension unit, it is possible to play the images record-  
ed on the pre-recording area.  
• Disk space size of each recording area differs depend-  
ing on the settings.  
Refer to a system administrator for further information.  
25  
n To stop playback, press the STOP button.  
n b  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and  
playback will stop.  
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Note: Pressing the PLAY/PAUSE button after stopping play-  
back will start playback from the end point of the  
recorded image played last time.  
BUSY  
c cv cv  
c Select a disk to be played using the jog dial  
and move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows  
button. Press the SET button to determine the  
selection.  
DISK SELECT  
HDD NORMAL/EVENT AREA  
HDD COPY AREA  
OK  
CANCEL  
The recording event list window will be displayed. (Refer to  
page 28 for further information.)  
To close the DISK SELECT window, move the cursor to  
select "CANCEL" and press the SET button.  
Important:  
In the following cases, the recording event list window will  
not be displayed even when you move the cursor to "OK"  
and press the SET button after selecting "HDD COPY  
AREA":  
• When another user has selected the HDD copy area  
• When copying is being performed manually in the HDD  
copy area using a PC via a network  
v Rotate the jog dial to select a desired recorded  
image to be played, and press the SET button  
to determine the selection.  
TIME&DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
TEXT  
UNLOCK FILTER  
TEXT  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
b Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to play the  
selected recorded image.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will light and play-  
back will start.  
26  
PLAYBACK FROM A DESIGNATED TIME AND DATE  
It is possible to play recorded images from a designated  
c Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will light and start  
playback from the entered time and date.  
time and date without stopping recording.  
Playback images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the  
VGA monitor.  
If there is no recorded image after the entered time:  
When there are images recorded after the entered time, the  
oldest recorded image after the entered time will be played.  
When there are no images recorded after the entered time,  
the newest recorded image before the entered time will be  
played.  
v c  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
v Press the STOP button.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and  
z
x
x
stop playback.  
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor.  
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the  
time and date designation window is dis-  
played.  
The time and date designation window will be displayed on  
monitor 2 and the VGA monitor.  
START  
:
:
1
JAN  
12  
00  
00 AM  
03  
.
.
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
x Enter the start time using the jog dial and the  
arrows button.  
Select the time and date using the jog dial. To move the  
cursor, use the arrows button (AB).  
START  
:
:
2
FEB  
12  
00  
00 AM  
04  
.
.
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
27  
SEARCH AND PLAY  
There are 3 ways to search for a recorded image and play it.  
• Search for a recording event and play it (Recording event search)  
• Search for a motion detected time and date from the recorded images and play it (VMD search)  
• Search for a marked point and play it (Marking search)  
Note: Playback images will be displayed on a single screen on monitor 2 and the VGA monitor. To play in a multi-screen,  
switch to a multi-screen after starting playback.  
I Search for a Recording Event and Play it back (Recording Event  
Search)  
Display a list or a thumbnail of recording events, and select the desired recording event from them to play it.  
It is possible to search using the following filters:  
Search Filters  
TIME & DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
Search for only images recorded in the entered time range.  
Search for only recorded images from the selected camera channel.  
Search for only images recorded in the selected recording mode.  
It is possible to search for images recorded in the following recording modes:  
EMERGENCY: Emergency recording (Refer to page 21.)  
VMD:  
TERMINAL:  
Event recording performed when motion was detected (Refer to page 32.)  
Event recording performed when a terminal alarm was detected.  
COMMAND: Event recording performed when a command alarm was detected.  
VIDEO LOSS: Event recording performed when video loss occurred.  
MANUAL:  
Manual recording (Refer to page 19.)  
SCHEDULE: Schedule recording (Refer to page 105.)  
Search for only images recorded with text information  
TEXT  
Recording Event List Window  
Searching filter buttons  
Filter cancel button  
TIME&DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
TEXT  
UNLOCK FILTER  
TEXT  
Recording event  
Text information  
Camera Channel  
Time and date  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
Time range of listed data  
Number of listed data  
Searching information  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
28  
Search filter buttons:  
Filter cancel button:  
Time and date:  
Selects the search filter  
Cancels the selected search filter and lists all recording events  
<When searched by recording event>  
The time when recording started will be displayed.  
<When searched by VMD>  
The time when motion was detected will be displayed.  
<When searched by marked point>  
The time when the point was marked will be displayed.  
The camera channel of the recorded image will be displayed. The recorded image of  
the displayed camera channel will be played on a single screen.  
The recording mode will be displayed.  
The first several characters of text information will be displayed if the image has text  
information.  
Camera channel:  
Recording event:  
Text information:  
Time range of the listed data:  
Number of the listed data:  
Search information:  
The time range of the listed data will be displayed.  
The number of the listed data will be displayed.  
The search filter will be displayed. (A filter of the currently displayed list will be dis-  
played in orange.)  
Recording Event Thumbnail Window  
Time and date  
Camera channel/Recording event  
Number of listed data  
Time and date:  
<When searched by recording event>  
The time when recording started will be displayed.  
<When searched by VMD>  
The time when motion was detected will be displayed.  
<When searched by marked point>  
The time when the point was marked will be displayed.  
Camera channel/Recording event: The camera channel of the recorded image will be displayed. The recorded image of  
the displayed camera channel will be played on a single screen. The recording mode  
also will be displayed.  
Number of the listed data:  
The number of the listed data will be displayed.  
Note: Some images displayed in the thumbnail window may not match with their respective displayed recorded time due to  
playing of compressed recorded images.  
29  
x Use the arrows button (AB) to select a search  
filter (TIME & DATE, CAMERA, EVENT, TEXT),  
and press the SET button.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
TIME&DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
TEXT  
UNLOCK FILTER  
TEXT  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
z z  
x
x
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the  
recording event list window is displayed.  
When a search filter is selected, the respective search filter  
window will be displayed.  
Select "UNLOCK FILTER" and press the SET button to can-  
cel the selected filter.  
TIME&DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
TEXT  
UNLOCK FILTER  
TEXT  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
Refer to page 28 about search filters.  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
The recording event list window will be displayed on moni-  
tor 2 and the VGA monitor.  
Use the arrows button (C D) to switch between displaying  
the list window and the thumbnail window alternately.  
To search using a search filter, go to step 4.  
TIME&DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
TEXT  
UNLOCK FILTER  
TEXT  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
<List window>  
<Thumbnail window>  
30  
Filter recording events by the recording event  
b
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REC EVENT FILTERING  
EMERGENCY OFF  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
VMD  
ON  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
TERMINAL ON  
COMMAND ON  
VIDEO LOSS ON  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
MANUAL  
SCHEDULE  
ON  
ON  
SET : [ SET ]  
CANCEL : [ ESC ]  
c
c
c
v
Move the cursor to select the recording event (refer to page  
28) using the arrows button (CD) and rotate the jog dial to  
ON.  
c Filter recording events.  
Filter recording events by time and date  
Press the SET button to determine the selection.  
The recording events of the selected filter will be listed.  
TIME&DATE FILTERING  
I
START  
Filter recording events by text information  
.
.
.
.
:
:
AM  
AM  
1
END  
1
JAN  
JAN  
03  
03  
00  
0
00  
00  
TEXT FILTERING  
WITHOUT TEXT  
SET : [SET] CANCEL : [ESC]  
Move the cursor using the arrows button and rotate the jog  
dial to enter the time and date.  
Press the SET button to determine the entered time and  
date.  
SET : [ SET ]  
CANCEL : [ ESC ]  
The recording event in the entered time range will be listed  
and displayed.  
Rotate the jog dial to select OFF, WITH TEXT or WITHOUT  
TEXT.  
Press the SET button to determine the selection.  
The recording events filtered by the selected filter will be  
listed.  
Filter recording events by camera channel  
CAMERA FILTERING  
CAMERA  
v Rotate the jog dial to select the recording event  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
to be played.  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
TIME&DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
TEXT  
UNLOCK FILTER  
TEXT  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
SET : [ SET ]  
CANCEL : [ ESC ]  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
Select camera channel numbers (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316,  
1 - 9 for the WJ-HD309) using the arrows button to apply fil-  
tering. It is possible to select camera channels using the  
camera selection buttons [1] - [16] for the WJ-HD316 ([1] -  
[9] for the WJ-HD309).  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM TOTAL  
12345  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
The selected camera channels will turn white.  
Press the SET button to determine the selection of camera  
channel numbers.  
It is possible to turn the page by rotating the shuttle ring.  
The recording events of the selected camera channels will  
be listed.  
b Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
The LISTED indicator and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE  
button will light and playback of the selected recording  
event will start.  
Note: When operating the system controller, select a cam-  
era channel using the numeric keypad. In this case, it is  
impossible to select 10 CH to 16 CH.  
Note: When the LISTED indicator is lit, only listed recording  
events are available to be played. Press the LISTED  
button during playback to make all recording events  
available to be played.  
31  
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the  
n
VMD search list is displayed.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
VMD SEARCH  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
TIME&DATE  
CAM  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
2
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
12345  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
n To stop playback, press the STOP button.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and  
playback will be stopped.  
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor.  
The result list of the VMD search will be displayed on moni-  
tor 2 and the VGA monitor.  
(The list in the displayed window is of the results of the pre-  
vious search.)  
Use the arrows button (C D) to switch between displaying  
the list window and the thumbnail window alternately.  
Important:  
In the recording event list, the start time of recording  
will be displayed.  
When events occurred successively, the contents of the  
event log and the recording event list will not always  
match since the unit continues to record the first occur-  
ring event.  
VMD SEARCH  
TIME&DATE  
CAM  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
12345  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
<List window>  
I Search for a motion detected  
time and date from the recorded  
images and play it (VMD search)  
Search for a motion detected time and date from all the  
images recorded in all the recording modes, and display a  
list or a thumbnail of the results.  
Select a time and date displayed on the result list or thumb-  
nail to play it.  
It is possible to filter by camera channel, time and date,  
detection area or search mode, to list the time and date of  
events that were recorded when motion was detected.  
z
<Thumbnail window>  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
2
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
32  
The motion detection area setup window will be displayed.  
To search using the same conditions as the previous  
search, press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
Go to step 12 when the VMD search is performed and a list  
of the results is displayed after the PLAY/PAUSE button is  
pressed.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
Note: If no image was recorded in the time range set in  
step 3, the motion detection area setup window will not  
be displayed when the SET button is pressed.  
cn xvn cb  
x Press the SET button.  
b Rotate the jog dial to select "SETUP AREA" on  
the status bar.  
SELECT CAMERA & DATE  
I
CAMERA  
CAM1  
START  
.
.
.
.
:
:
AM  
AM  
1
END  
1
JAN  
JAN  
03  
03  
12  
12  
00  
00  
SET : [SET] SEARCH : [PLAY] CANCEL : [ESC]  
The VMD search window will be displayed.  
Enter a camera channel number and time range on the  
VMD search window for the VMD search.  
To search using the same conditions as the previous  
search, press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
Note: It is possible to set all displayed areas as motion  
detection areas by pressing the SET button after select-  
ing "ALL AREAS".  
Go to step 12 when the VMD search is performed and a list  
of the results is displayed after the PLAY/PAUSE button is  
pressed.  
n Move the cross cursor using the arrows button  
to a point to be determined as the start point of  
the motion detection area.  
c Move the cursor using the arrows button and  
rotate the jog dial to enter the camera channel  
number and time range for the VMD search.  
SELECT CAMERA & DATE  
I
CAMERA  
CAM1  
START  
.
.
.
.
:
:
AM  
AM  
1
END  
1
JAN  
JAN  
03  
03  
12  
12  
00  
00  
Press the SET button to determine the selected point as the  
start point of the motion detection area.  
SET : [SET] SEARCH : [PLAY] CANCEL : [ESC]  
v Press the SET button.  
33  
Select the sensitivity using the arrows button  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
(DC) from the following.  
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
OFF: Motion will not be detected  
LOW: Low sensitivity  
MID: Standard sensitivity  
HIGH: High sensitivity  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
m.⁄  
m
,
Rotate the jog dial to select "EXIT" on the sta-  
tus bar to exit from the motion detection area  
setup window.  
m Move the cross cursor using the arrows button  
to a point to be determined as the end point of  
the motion detection area.  
Press the SET button to determine the selected point as the  
end point of the motion detection area.  
It is possible to set up to 4 motion detection areas by  
repeating steps 6 and 7.  
, Rotate the jog dial to select "SENSITIVITY" on  
the status bar.  
Note: Depending on the position of the set detection areas,  
the sensitivity indications of the detection areas may be  
displayed overlapping each other.  
. Move the cross cursor to the motion detection  
area to apply the sensitivity using the arrows  
button (AB).  
34  
Press the SET button or the PLAY/PAUSE but-  
ton to start searching and display the results  
of the VMD search.  
⁄ ⁄⁄  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
VMD SEARCH  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
TIME&DATE  
CAM  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
⁄⁄ ⁄⁄  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
12345  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
Move the cursor to select a detection mode  
using the arrow buttons and rotate the jog dial  
to check the radio button next to the selected  
detection mode. Press the SET button to deter-  
mine the selection.  
Up to 200 results will be displayed. (When 200 results are  
listed, searching will stop.)  
Notes:  
• It may take some time until the search results are dis-  
played.  
VMD SEARCH  
I
ANY AREA  
• It is possible to stop searching by pressing the STOP  
button.  
MASKING DURATION  
24h  
VECTOR  
A
20s  
DURATION  
20s  
B
20s  
C
C
20s  
20s  
D
D
A
B
20s  
20s  
Rotate the jog dial to select a result to be dis-  
played.  
SET : [SET] SEARCH : [PLAY] CANCEL : [ESC]  
VMD SEARCH  
Refer to page 36 for further information about each of the  
detection modes.  
TIME&DATE  
CAM  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
<ANY AREA mode>  
Move the cursor to the parameter box using the arrows but-  
ton (C) to select a masking duration from the following.  
1 s/1 m/1 h/24 h  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
12345  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
<VECTOR mode>  
It is possible to turn the page by rotating the shuttle ring.  
Move the cursor to an area for the settings of VECTOR  
using the arrows button (C) and rotate the jog dial to select  
an area. Move the cursor to the parameter box of the  
selected area using the arrows button (B) to select an  
interval time for an object moving between each area from  
the following.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to start play-  
back.  
The LISTED indicator and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE  
button will light and playback of the selected recording will  
start.  
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m  
Note: It is possible to skip from the playback point to the  
listed time (motion detected time) by rotating the jog  
dial when the LISTED indicator is lit.  
<DURATION>  
Move the cursor to the parameter box of each area using  
the arrows button (B) and rotate the jog dial to select a  
moving duration for an object in each area from the follow-  
ing.  
To return to normal playback, press the LISTED button.  
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m  
Press the STOP button to stop playback.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and  
playback will be stopped.  
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor.  
35  
Any motion will be detected anywhere in the A, B, C, D  
areas.  
I To delete the motion detection  
area  
Note: In the ANY AREA mode, it is possible to set the  
masking duration. When the masking duration is set,  
motion will be ignored for a certain period (set duration  
as the masking duration) in the same area. It is conve-  
nient to set the masking duration to make the subject  
period shorter in case it is necessary to search an  
extended time range or when searching through many  
results.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
<VECTOR mode>  
zx  
x
It will be subject to listing if an object moves within the set  
time to the other detection areas in the set order.  
The following is an example.  
z Rotate the jog dial to select "DELETE AREA"  
on the status bar.  
10 s  
A
C
B
D
10 s  
Motion is detected in area B within 10 seconds after being  
detected in area A.  
Motion is detected in area C within 20 seconds after being  
detected in area B.  
Note: To delete all the motion detection areas, select  
"DELETE ALL AREA" and press the SET button.  
Motion is detected in area D within 10 seconds after being  
detected in area C.  
When all of the above have occurred, an event action will  
be performed.  
x Move the cursor to the motion detection area  
to be deleted using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
The selected area will be deleted.  
<DURATION mode>  
It will be subject to listing if an object keeps moving for the  
set period in the detection area. For example, in case of the  
following settings; 10 sec. for areas A and B, 20 sec. for  
area C and 30 sec. for area D:  
An event action will be performed when an object keeps  
moving longer than the set period in the specified detection  
area.  
Detection Mode  
Set how to detect motion in the set motion detection area.  
There are 3 detection modes as follows:  
Important:  
It is impossible to set two or more detection modes  
simultaneously.  
A
C
B
D
<ANY AREA mode>  
It will be subject to listing if "motion" is detected in any of  
the set motion detection areas.  
A
C
B
D
Important:  
• When images to be searched are recorded with a low  
recording rate, the DURATION mode may not work cor-  
rectly.  
• It may take some time to search according to the con-  
tents of the recorded images.  
36  
To delete all displayed marking lists, press the camera  
selection buttons [1] and [2] simultaneously for 2 seconds  
or more when displaying the marking list window.  
I Search for a marked point and  
play from that point (Marking  
search)  
Display the recording time of the recorded images with a  
marked point in a list or a thumbnail and select the desired  
recording time to play. Refer to page 24 for further informa-  
tion about marking.  
x Rotate the jog dial or the shuttle ring to select  
the desired marked time.  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
TEXT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
v c z  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
c Press the PLAY/PAUSE button.  
z
x x  
The LISTED indicator and the indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE  
button will light, and playback of a recorded image from the  
selected marked time will start.  
z Press the SEARCH button repeatedly until the  
Notes:  
marking list window is displayed.  
• It is possible to skip from the playback point to the list-  
ed time (marked time) by rotating the jog dial when the  
LISTED indicator is lit.  
To return to normal playback, press the LISTED button.  
• It is possible that some recorded images with marked  
points may have been deleted by overwrite recording  
or the delete function.  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
TEXT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
v Press the STOP button.  
The indicator on the PLAY/PAUSE button will go off and  
playback will be stopped.  
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor.  
The result list of the marking search will be displayed on  
monitor 2 and the VGA monitor.  
Use the arrows button (C D) to switch between displaying  
the list window and the thumbnail window alternately.  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
TEXT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
37  
MONITOR LIVE IMAGES  
It is possible to display live images on a single screen or a  
multi-screen.  
I Electronic Zoom  
When displaying a single screen, zooming in on the dis-  
played image is possible.  
Electronic zoom is available only on the selected monitor.  
When the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 indicator is lit (the moni-  
tor 1 is selected), electronic zoom works only on monitor 1.  
On a single sequential display (It is also possible that dis-  
played images from cameras will be switched automatical-  
ly)  
I Displaying Live Images on a  
[WJ-HD316]  
Single Screen  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
[WJ-HD316]  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
z
x
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
3
7
4
8
PRESET  
/AUTO  
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
2
SET  
13  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
BUSY  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
6
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
z x  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
[WJ-HD309]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
[WJ-HD309]  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
z
x
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
IRIS  
LISTED  
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
2
SET  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
BUSY  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
z
x
BUSY  
z Press the SHIFT button when monitoring live  
images on a single screen.  
z Press the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 button to  
The SHIFT indicator will light.  
select the monitor.  
When monitor 1 is selected, the indicator will light.  
When monitor 2 or the VGA monitor is selected, the indica-  
tor will not light.  
x Press the EL-ZOOM button to enlarge the dis-  
played image.  
The displayed image will be displayed with x2 zoomed  
size.  
x Press a camera selection button  
(1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9 for the WJ-  
HD309) to select a camera.  
Zooming level will change each time the EL-ZOOM button  
is pressed.  
x2 x4 OFF  
Live images from the selected camera will be displayed  
and the respective camera selection button will light green  
or blue.  
When monitor 2 is selected, live images will be displayed  
on the VGA monitor.  
Notes:  
• When an image is zoomed in on (x2 or x4), it is possible  
to move the zoomed image using the arrows button.  
• When any indicator of PAN/TILT, ZOOM/FOCUS, IRIS,  
PRESET/AUTO is lit, it is impossible to use the EL-  
ZOOM function.  
38  
The camera selection buttons respective to the live images  
displayed on a multi-screen will light green or blue.  
I Displaying on a Multi-screen  
It is possible to display images on a multi-screen (4, 7, 9,  
10, 13, 16 for the WJ-HD316, 4, 7, 9 for the WJ-HD309).  
[WJ-HD316]  
z
c
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
When monitor 2 is selected in step 1, live images will also  
be displayed on the selected multi-screen on the VGA mon-  
itor.  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
x
To display on a single screen  
[WJ-HD309]  
Press the SHIFT button. The SHIFT indicator will go off.  
Press any of the camera selection buttons.  
Live images will be displayed on a single screen.  
z
c
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
When displaying on a 4-split screen  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
Each time the camera selection button 4 is pressed, the  
displayed camera channels will be changed as follows:  
WJ-HD316: 1-4 CH – 5-8 CH – 9-12 CH – 13-16 CH  
WJ-HD309: 1-4 CH – 5-8 CH – 9 CH  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
BUSY  
x
When displaying on a 9-split screen  
Each time the camera selection button 9 is pressed, the  
displayed camera channels will be changed as follows:  
Only for the WJ-HD316: 1-9 CH – 10-16 CH  
z Press the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 button to  
select the monitor.  
When monitor 1 is selected, the indicator will light.  
When monitor 2 is selected, the indicator will not light.  
x Press the SHIFT button.  
The SHIFT indicator will light.  
c Press a camera selection button 1 - 6 (1 - 3 for  
the WJ-HD309) to select a desired multi-  
screen.  
Camera selection button 1: 4-split screen  
Camera selection button 2: 7-split screen  
Camera selection button 3: 9-split screen  
Camera selection button 4: 16-split screen (Only for the WJ-  
HD316)  
Camera selection button 5: 10-split screen (Only for the WJ-  
HD316)  
Camera selection button 6: 13-split screen (Only for the WJ-  
HD316)  
39  
I Sequential Display  
Displayed images from cameras will be switched automati-  
cally.  
Camera images will be displayed sequentially according to  
the settings performed in advance.  
[WJ-HD316]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
[WJ-HD309]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
BUSY  
z Press the MONITOR1/MONITOR2 button to  
select the monitor.  
When monitor 1 is selected, the indicator will light.  
When monitor 2 is selected, the indicator will not light.  
x Press the SHIFT button.  
The SHIFT indicator will light.  
c Press the SEQ button.  
The camera selection button respective to the displayed  
image will light green.  
To stop sequential display, press the SEQ button.  
When trying to display on a single screen or multi-screen  
during the sequential display, the sequential display will be  
stopped.  
When monitor 2 is selected in step 1, the sequential display  
will also start on the VGA monitor.  
40  
CONTROL CAMERAS  
When displaying live images, the following camera controls  
are possible.  
• Panning/tilting: Moves a camera horizontally/vertically.  
I Zoom  
Zooms in/out on images. Depending on models of the con-  
nected cameras, the image size for the respective zooming  
level may be different. For further information, refer to the  
operating instruction for the camera.  
• Zooming:  
• Focus:  
Zooms in/out on images.  
Adjusts the focus.  
• Iris:  
• Preset action:  
Adjusts the iris of the lens.  
Moves a camera to the preset position  
registered in advance.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
• Auto function:  
Moves a camera with an auto function  
set in advance.  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
Notes:  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
• Controlling cameras is possible only when displaying  
images on a single screen.  
• Depending on models of the connected cameras, it  
may be impossible to control the camera or some func-  
tions may not be available.  
z
x
c
• When a user with higher priority is controlling the select-  
ed camera, it may be impossible to control the camera.  
Refer to page 66 for further information about priority.  
• Refer to page 127 for descriptions of how to display  
and perform the settings with the settings menu of the  
camera from this unit.  
z Press the ZOOM/FOCUS button.  
The ZOOM/FOCUS indicator will light.  
x Use the arrows button (CD) to zoom in on or  
out of the displayed image.  
Press the arrows button downward (C) to zoom out and  
upward (D) to zoom in.  
I Panning/Tilting  
Moves a camera horizontally/vertically.  
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for  
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)  
respective to the controlled camera channel to  
quit the zooming operation.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
2
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
I Focus  
Adjusts the focus. The auto focus function is available.  
c
zx x  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
z Press the PAN/TILT button.  
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
The PAN/TILT indicator will light.  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
x Use the arrows button to adjust the vertical or  
horizontal position.  
z
x x  
c
Camera will move slowly by pressing the arrows button  
while holding the PAN/TILT SLOW button down.  
z Press the FOCUS button.  
The ZOOM/FOCUS indicator will light.  
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for  
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)  
respective to the controlled camera channel to  
quit the panning/tilting operation.  
41  
x Use the arrows button (AB) to adjust the  
I Preset Action  
Moves a camera to the preset position registered in  
focus.  
Press the arrows button (A) to shift the focus farther.  
Press the arrows button (B) to shift the focus nearer.  
Auto focus is available by pressing the SET button.  
advance.  
Important:  
• When using a camera of the WV-CS650 (WV-CSR650)  
series or the WV-CS600 (WV-CSR600) series, register  
preset positions using the settings menu of the camera.  
• When the monitor 1 is selected, it is impossible to regis-  
ter preset positions and move a camera to a preset  
position by performing the following steps.  
In this case, perform the settings using the setup menu  
of camera.  
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for  
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)  
respective to the controlled camera channel to  
quit the focusing operation.  
I Iris  
Adjusts the iris of the lens.  
Register Preset Positions of Cameras  
Up to 64 preset positions can be registered.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
[WJ-HD316]  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
IRIS  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
LOGOUT  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
SET  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
13  
14  
15  
16  
REPEAT  
BUSY  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
z
x x  
c
x
z
z Press the IRIS button.  
The IRIS indicator will light.  
[WJ-HD309]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
x Use the arrows button (AB) to adjust the iris.  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
Press the arrows button (A) to close the iris.  
Press the arrows button (B) to open the iris.  
To reset the set iris, press the SET button.  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
SET  
BUSY  
x
z
c Press the camera selection button ([1] - [16] for  
the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9] for the WJ-HD309)  
respective to the controlled camera channel to  
quit the iris operation.  
z Press the PAN/TILT button and move the cam-  
era to a desired position to be registered as a  
preset position.  
x Press the SET button. The REGISTRATION  
PRESET POSITION window will be displayed.  
REGISTRATION PRESET POSITION  
32  
PRESET NUMBER  
OK  
CANCEL  
42  
[WJ-HD316]  
I Move a camera to the preset  
position  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
[WJ-HD316]  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
SET  
13  
REV  
FWD  
BUSY  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
c
v v  
c
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
SET  
13  
[WJ-HD309]  
BUSY  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
z
c
c
x
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
[WJ-HD309]  
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
SET  
REV  
FWD  
BUSY  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
c
v v  
c
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
SET  
BUSY  
c Press a camera selection button  
([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for  
the WJ-HD309) to register a preset position  
number.  
z
c
c
x
The pressed button number will be registered as a preset  
position number.  
The jog dial also can be used to select a preset position  
number by rotating it.  
z Press the PRESET/AUTO button.  
The PRESET/AUTO indicator will light and the PRESET/  
AUTO PAN window will be displayed.  
Up to 64 can be registered as preset position numbers.  
x Press a camera selection button  
([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for  
the WJ-HD309) to select a desired preset posi-  
tion.  
v Select "OK" using the arrows button and press  
the SET button.  
The adjusted camera position (currently displayed on the  
monitor) will be registered as a preset position with the  
selected preset position number.  
To cancel the selected preset position, select "CANCEL"  
using the arrows button and press the SET button. The set-  
ting will be canceled and the REGISTRATION PRESET  
POSITION window will be closed.  
Pressing the camera selection button [10/0] ([0] for the WJ-  
HD309) moves a camera to the home position.  
The jog dial can also be used to select a preset position  
number by rotating it.  
PRESET / AUTO PAN  
PRESET  
32  
PRESET NUMBER  
AUTO PAN  
OK  
CANCEL  
c Select "OK" using the arrows button and press  
the SET button.  
The PRESET/AUTO PAN window will be closed and the  
camera will move to the selected preset position.  
When selecting "CANCEL" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button, the PRESET/AUTO PAN window will  
be closed.  
43  
Note: To move the camera to another registered preset  
position, press the SET button after selecting a desired  
preset position number in step 2. The PRESET/AUTO  
PAN window will not close and it is possible to select  
another preset number.  
Note: Refer to the operating instructions of the camera for  
further information about the auto function of the cam-  
era in use.  
I Auto Function (Auto Pan, etc)  
Moves a camera with an auto function set in advance.  
Important:  
When monitor 1 is selected, it is impossible to move a  
camera with an auto function by performing the follow-  
ing steps.  
In this case, perform the settings using the setup menu  
of camera.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
c
x
z
xc  
z Press the PRESET/AUTO button.  
The PRESET/AUTO indicator will light and the PRESET/  
AUTO PAN window will be displayed.  
x Move the cursor to "AUTO PAN" using the  
arrows button and check the radio button next  
to "AUTO PAN" using the jog dial.  
PRESET / AUTO PAN  
PRESET  
32  
PRESET NUMBER  
AUTO PAN  
OK  
CANCEL  
c Select "OK" using the arrows button and press  
the SET button.  
The PRESET/AUTO PAN window will be closed and auto  
function will start.  
During auto function, it is impossible to register a preset  
position. To close the PRESET/AUTO PAN window, select  
"CANCEL" using the arrows button and press the SET but-  
ton. The setting will be canceled and the PRESET/AUTO  
PAN window will be closed.  
44  
ABOUT THE EVENT FUNCTION  
The event action will be performed when the following  
events occur.  
Motion detection: When motion is detected by the  
motion detection function (see below), this is stated as  
an event of motion detection.  
Activity Detection Mode (ACT DET)  
This mode records images in the place where an event  
occurred without announcing it.  
Video Loss: When a video signal supply is stopped  
because of a cable disconnection or malfunction of a  
camera, this is stated as an event of video loss.  
Terminal alarm: When a signal is supplied from an  
external device such as a door sensor to the ALARM  
terminal, this is stated as an event of the terminal alarm.  
Command alarm: When a command alarm is supplied  
from a PC connected to the SERIAL connector on the  
rear panel of this unit, this is stated as an event of the  
command alarm.  
Activity Detection  
Event Action  
Start recording  
Alarm Mode  
Mode  
Displays event information  
on the monitor.  
Blinks the alarm indicator.  
Sounds the buzzer.  
* Switches from a displayed  
image to the image from  
the location of the alarm  
occurrence.  
About the Motion Detection Function (VMD)  
An alarm signal will be supplied when motion (luminance  
transition) is detected in a designated area. It is possible to  
save images recorded in the place where motion is detect-  
ed, or send e-mails when motion is detected.  
Refer to a system administrator for further information about  
the required settings for the motion detection function such  
as the settings of the detection area.  
* Moves a camera to the  
preset position.  
* Announces an event  
occurrence by sending e-  
mails.  
* Announces an event  
occurrence by the  
PS·Data/Serial (RS232C)  
commands.  
Supplies a signal from the  
ALARM connector or the  
ALARM/CONTROL connec-  
tor on the rear panel of this  
unit (Alarm signal output).  
I Action at an event occurrence  
The event action will be performed according to the set-  
tings when an event occurs.  
Records the event log.  
There are 2 event action modes for the alarm mode  
(ALARM) and the activity detection mode (ACT DET) for  
each event type. The event action will be different accord-  
ing to the event action mode set.  
When an event of the alarm mode (ALARM) occurs, this unit  
activates the alarm action.  
* Transmits images to an  
FTP server  
: Applicable  
– : Not applicable  
* : Available only when using a PC via a network (Refer to  
the Network Setup Instructions (PDF) for further informa-  
tion.)  
About the event action mode  
Alarm Mode (ALARM)  
This mode announces an event occurrence outside. Action  
taken in the alarm mode is referred to as the alarm action.  
45  
Displays the event information in the alarm  
display area on monitor 1 and the camera  
title display area on monitor 2  
I Alarm Function  
Blinks the ALARM indicator on the front  
panel  
TIMER  
ERROR  
ALARM  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
ALARM  
RESET  
HDD 1  
HDD 2  
OPERATE  
<Monitor 1>  
Switches from the images displayed on  
monitor 1 and monitor 2 to the images from  
the location of the alarm occurrence (on a  
single screen)  
<Monitor 2>  
Sounds the buzzer  
Contact a system administrator about sounding duration.  
Announces an event occurrence to the con-  
nected system device (Alarm Output)  
Sends  
a
signal to the device connected to the  
ALARM/CONTROL connector, and the connected device  
such as a buzzer will be activated.  
Starts recording automatically  
Starts recording the image from the location of the event  
occurrence automatically.  
Moves a camera to the preset position  
A camera will move to the preset position registered in  
advance.  
Announces an event occurrence by sending  
e-mails  
E-mails will be sent to addresses registered in advance.  
Refer to the Network Operating Instructions (PDF) on the  
provided CD-ROM.  
46  
I Cancel the Alarm Action  
I Suspend the Alarm Actions  
It is possible to suspend (deactivate temporarily) the alarm  
When an alarm has occurred, this unit will start the alarm  
action according to the selected alarm action mode.  
To cancel the alarm action, press the ALARM RESET but-  
ton.  
When "ON" is selected for "Alarm Auto Reset" (on the "Alarm  
Setup" menu of "Event"), the following will be performed  
automatically even if the alarm action is not canceled by  
pressing the ALARM RESET button on the front panel.  
actions even when an event has occurred.  
This function will be useful when it is necessary not to acti-  
vate the alarm actions for a certain period, such as when  
configuring the system. However, images and event logs  
will be recorded even when alarm actions are suspended.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FW  
TIMER  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
• The ALARM indicator will stop blinking and light steadi-  
ly  
ERROR  
SEARCH  
M
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
ALARM  
RESET  
D
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
• The displayed alarm information will disappear  
• The buzzer will stop beeping  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
HDD 1  
HDD 2  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
E
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
zx  
zx  
TIMER  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
ERROR  
ALARM  
A  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
ALARM  
RESET  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
HDD 1  
HDD 2  
OPERATE  
13  
To suspend (deactivate temporarily)  
the alarm actions  
z
z Press both the ALARM RESET button and the  
SET button at the same time.  
The ALARM SUSPEND indicator will light.  
z Press the ALARM RESET button to cancel the  
alarm actions.  
The ALARM indicator will go off.  
To stop suspending the alarm  
actions  
x Press both the ALARM RESET button and the  
SET button at the same time again.  
The ALARM SUSPEND indicator will go off.  
Note: When an external switch is connected to the  
ALARM/CONTROL connector on the rear panel, it is  
possible to suspend the alarm actions using the exter-  
nal switch.  
In this case, the alarm actions will be suspended when  
the external switch is on.  
To stop suspending the alarm actions, set the external  
switch to off.  
47  
COPYING (Duplicate)  
It is possible to copy (duplicate) manually the images  
recorded on the disk area selected with the DISK SELECT  
window (page 25) to the HDD copy area or the external  
recording device (DVD-RAM disk, DVD-R disk, CD-R disk)  
connected to the unit.  
z Press the SHIFT button.  
The SHIFT indicator will light.  
To copy recorded images during playback, pause the play-  
back temporarily.  
It is recommended to make back-up copies on a regular  
basis for unexpected situations such as malfunction of the  
hard disk.  
x Press the COPY button.  
Manual copy is available during the following.  
• While displaying live images  
DATA COPY  
CAMERA  
• While pausing playback of recorded images  
• When displaying a search window (Recording event list  
window, VMD search list window, Marking list window)  
(Manual copy is not available when a thumbnail window  
is displayed.)  
1
9
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
PERIOD  
.
.
.
.
:
1
1
JAN  
JAN  
03  
03  
12  
00  
05  
AM  
AM  
:
12  
COPY DRIVE  
HDD COPY AREA  
COPY 1  
OK  
COPY 2  
CANCEL  
Notes:  
• The auto copy function is available for copying record-  
ed images to the DVD-RAM disk automatically. When  
the auto copy function is enabled, manual copy is not  
available. Refer to a system administrator for further  
information about the auto copy function.  
• To copy during playback of recorded images, pause  
the playback temporarily.  
• To copy recorded images on the DVD-RAM disk, for-  
matting (initializing) the DVD-RAM disk is required in  
advance. Refer to page 52 for the descriptions of how  
to format DVD-RAM disks.  
• Copy time may differ depending on the size of the  
recorded image. It may take longer to copy images  
recorded in higher quality and resolution even when  
selecting the same number of cameras and designating  
the same recording duration.  
The DATA COPY window will be displayed on monitor 2  
and the VGA monitor.  
The DATA COPY window will not be displayed when a  
thumbnail window is displayed.  
In this case, display a list window using the arrows button  
(CD).  
Notes:  
• When the auto copy function is enabled, the DATA  
COPY window will not be displayed.  
• The copy cancel window will be displayed if the user  
who started manual copy presses the COPY button dur-  
ing the manual copy. (It is impossible to stop manual  
copy performed by other users.)  
c Perform the settings for data copy (camera  
channel, time range, the disk on which images  
are to be copied). Move the cursor to each set-  
ting item using the arrows button and select a  
parameter by rotating the jog dial.  
[WJ-HD316]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
Note: Time range to be set for "PERIOD" should be 30 min-  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
utes or less to copy images for one attempt.  
z
x
c
c
[WJ-HD309]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
BUSY  
z
x
c
c
48  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
v v  
v Select the "OK" button using the arrows button  
and press the SET button.  
The DATA COPY window will be closed and data copy will  
start.  
The copy icon will be displayed on the task bar during  
copying.  
To close the DATA COPY window, select "CANCEL" using  
the arrows button and press the SET button. The setting will  
be canceled and the DATA COPY window will be closed.  
Copy icon  
In the following cases, copying will not start even when you  
move the cursor to "OK" and press the SET button:  
• When another user has selected the desired copy drive  
• When copying is being performed manually  
Important:  
• To eject the disk, do the following while live images are  
displayed.  
<To eject the disk of COPY1>  
Confirm the SHIFT indicator is lit. Then, press the COPY  
button and [1] simultaneously for 2 seconds or more.  
<To eject the disk of COPY2>  
Confirm the SHIFT indicator is lit. Then, press the COPY  
button and [2] simultaneously for 2 seconds or more.  
• Copying will be performed in the following order:  
Viewer Software Images Audio  
Depending on the set time range for "PERIOD", some of  
images and audio may not be copied.  
• Use the viewer software to play the copied images.  
Refer to the Network Operating Instructions (PDF) for  
descriptions of how to play the copied images.  
49  
DELETE DATA ON THE DISK  
Perform the settings for the built-in hard disk of the unit, the  
optional extension unit and the DVD-RAM disk. These are  
the descriptions of how to delete recorded images on the  
hard disk and how to format a DVD-RAM disk.  
Refer to a system administrator for further information about  
the other disks.  
x Move the cursor to "Maintenance" using the  
arrows button (CDAB) and press the SET  
button.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
I Deletion of recorded images  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
saved on the hard disk manually  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
Delete recorded images saved in the normal area or the  
event area of the built-in hard disk or the optional extension  
unit manually.  
By setting a time and date, images in the normal record  
area of the hard disk recorded before the set time and date  
will be deleted.  
c Move the cursor to "Data Delete" using the  
arrows button (CD).  
The "Data Delete" menu will be displayed.  
Manually delete unwanted images on the hard disk.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
Important:  
LIVE  
Auto Delete  
REC Rate  
I
I
OFF  
It is impossible to recover the deleted images.  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN 03  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
Disk Info  
.
.
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
I
I
.
JAN  
DELETE  
.
03  
Note: It is possible to delete recorded images automatically  
when the set days have passed from the day the image  
was recorded (Auto Delete). Refer to a system adminis-  
trator for further information.  
COPY1  
COPY2  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
z
v Press the SET button.  
The cursor will be displayed on the "Data Delete" menu.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
LISTED  
SETUP MENU  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
LIVE  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
Auto Delete  
REC Rate  
I
I
OFF  
2
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN 03  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
BUSY  
Disk Info  
.
.
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
I
I
.
JAN  
.
03  
DELETE  
COPY1  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
COPY2  
v
xc  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or  
more.  
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the  
VGA monitor.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
50  
m
, Press the SET button for 2 seconds or more.  
The SETUP MENU will be closed and the live images will be  
displayed.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
2
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
n, b  
bn  
b Move the cursor to "Manual Delete for Normal  
Recording Area" or "Manual Delete for Event  
Recording Area" using the arrows button, and  
set time and date using the jog dial.  
The images recorded the day before the set time and date  
will be subject to be deleted.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Auto Delete  
REC Rate  
I
I
OFF  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN 03  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
Disk Info  
.
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
I
I
.
JAN  
DELETE  
.
03  
COPY1  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
COPY2  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
n Move the cursor to "DELETE" using the arrows  
button and press the SET button.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Auto Delete  
REC Rate  
I
I
OFF  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN 03  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
Disk Info  
.
.
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
I
I
.
JAN  
.
03  
DELETE  
COPY1  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
COPY2  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
m Select "OK" using the arrows button and press  
the SETUP/ESC button.  
Normal recording area is going  
to be erased.  
OK  
CANCEL  
To cancel delete, select "CANCEL".  
51  
FORMAT (INITIALIZE) A DVD-RAM DISK  
To copy (duplicate) recorded images onto the DVD-RAM  
disk, formatting (initializing) the DVD-RAM disk is required  
in advance.  
c Select "Data Delete" using the arrows button  
(CD).  
To delete images recorded on the DVD-RAM disk, format-  
ting (initialization) of the DVD-RAM disk is also required.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Auto Delete  
REC Rate  
I
I
OFF  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN 03  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
Disk Info  
.
.
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
Important:  
I
I
.
JAN  
.
03  
DELETE  
All data on the disk will be deleted if formatted (initial-  
ized). It is impossible to recover the deleted images.  
COPY1  
COPY2  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
z
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
v Press the SET button.  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
The cursor will be displayed on the "Data Delete" menu.  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
2
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Auto Delete  
REC Rate  
I
I
OFF  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN 03  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
Disk Info  
.
.
xcb xv  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
I
I
.
JAN  
DELETE  
.
03  
COPY1  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
COPY2  
Event Log  
Error Log  
z Press the ESC/SETUP button for 2 seconds or  
Access Log  
more.  
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the  
VGA monitor.  
b Select either"COPY1" or "COPY2" (port to  
which the DVD-RAM is connected) for "Disc  
Format of DVD" using the arrows button.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Auto Delete  
I
I
OFF  
Event Log  
Error Log  
REC Rate  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Disk Info  
.
.
03  
03  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
I
I
.
JAN  
DELETE  
.
COPY1  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
COPY2  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
x Select "Maintenance" using the arrows button  
and press the SET button.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
52  
,
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
nm  
m
n Press the SET button to select "FORMAT".  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
All of data in the COPY1 is going  
to be erased.  
OK  
CANCEL  
m Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows but-  
ton and press the SET button to start format-  
ting.  
To stop formatting, select "CANCEL" and press the SET but-  
ton.  
During formatting, the status window will be displayed.  
The status window will be closed automatically after com-  
pleting formatting.  
, Press the SETUP/ESC button to close the  
SETUP MENU window.  
Live images will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor.  
53  
DISPLAY/EDIT TEXT INFORMATION  
It is possible to attach text information to images when  
recording.  
Entering 20 characters for a line (up to 10 lines, with a total  
of 200 characters) is possible.  
x Press the SHIFT button.  
The SHIFT indicator will light.  
These are the descriptions of how to display/edit the  
attached text information for images.  
c Press the TEXT button to display the TEXT  
INFORMATION window.  
Note: Displaying/editing text information is possible during  
the following.  
TEXT INFORMATION  
• While pausing playback on a single screen  
• While displaying the recording event list window  
[WJ-HD316]  
cv  
z
EDIT : [TEXT] SET : [SET] CANCEL : [ESC]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
5
2
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
Text information attached to the paused playback image or  
text information attached to the selected recording event  
will be displayed.  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
6
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
13  
To close the TEXT INFORMATION window, press the  
SETUP/ESC button or the SET button.  
BUSY  
x
z
[WJ-HD309]  
v Press the TEXT button again to edit text infor-  
mation.  
cv  
z
PLAY  
STOP  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
TEXT INFORMATION  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
BUSY  
x
z
EXT : [TEXT]  
z <While pausing playback on a single screen>  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to stop play-  
back.  
<While displaying the recording event list win-  
dow>  
Select a desired recording event by rotating  
the jog dial.  
TIME&DATE  
CAMERA  
REC EVENT  
TEXT  
UNLOCK FILTER  
TEXT  
TIME&DATE  
CAM REC EVT  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 01ch MANUAL ABCDEFGHIJ  
25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM 25.APR.03*12:34:56 AM  
TOTAL  
100  
TIME&DATE SEARCH REC EVENT SEARCH VMD SEARCH MARK  
54  
Important:  
It is impossible to edit text information using the system  
controller.  
[WJ-HD316]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
2
SET  
13  
BUSY  
b
n
b
[WJ-HD309]  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
R
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
R
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
TEXT  
COPY  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
6
9
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
REPEAT  
+
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
SET  
BUSY  
b
n
b
b Edit text information using the arrows button  
and the jog dial.  
To insert a character  
Move the cursor to a desired point where a character is  
to be inserted using the arrows button, and select a  
character using the jog dial.  
To delete a character  
Move the cursor to a character to be deleted using the  
arrows button, and press the STOP button.  
To delete all characters  
Press the STOP button for 2 seconds or more.  
Available characters  
The following characters can be entered:  
A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z a  
b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z 0 12 3 4 5 6  
7 8 9!"#$%' ()*+, - ./: ;<=>?@[ \ ] ^ _`{|}~  
Press the TEXT button after editing text.  
n Press the SET button to apply the edited char-  
acters.  
TEXT INFORMATION  
Digital Disc Recorder WJ-HD316  
EDIT : [TEXT] SET : [SET] CANCEL : [ESC]  
To cancel the edit, press the SETUP/ESC button. The edit-  
ed characters will not be applied.  
55  
ERROR/WARNINGS  
The "error" status  
When a fatal error (one that might cause the system to go down) has occurred, the ERROR indicator will blink red and the  
error indication will be displayed on the monitor 2.  
The "warning" status  
When an error (even though it has not caused the system trouble yet, but which may become a fatal error) has occurred,  
the ERROR indicator will blink orange.  
• When the buzzer sounding duration has passed from the error occurrence or the ALARM RESET button is pressed, the  
error indication will disappear and the blinking ERROR indicator will light steadily. (Error half-reset)  
If the error is eliminated, the ERROR indicator will go off when the ALARM RESET button is pressed while the ERROR indi-  
cator is lit. (Error reset)  
At an error occurrence  
In the error half-reset  
condition  
In the error reset condition  
Off  
ERROR indicator on the  
front panel  
Blinks  
Lights steadily  
Sounds (when it has been  
set)  
Stops  
Stops  
Buzzer  
Error display area on the  
main bar  
Displays  
Displays  
Does not display  
Does not output  
The error output (pin no.18)  
of the ALARM/CONTROL  
connector  
Outputs  
Does not output  
Problem mail  
Transmitted (When it has  
been set)  
Error log  
Filed  
Indication  
ALT-*  
Status  
Description  
Solution  
Error  
Error  
Recorded image has been altered.  
Playback will be paused.  
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
cel the error status. The unit will be in  
the error half-reset/error reset condition.  
Press the PLAY/PAUSE button to resume  
playback.  
W-ERROR  
Failed to write data on the HDD.  
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
cel the error status. The unit will be in  
the error half-reset/error reset condition.  
When the "W-ERROR" indication is dis-  
played frequently, contact the dealer to  
replace the hard disk drive.  
SMART  
Warning  
Warning  
The hard disk may be malfunctioning  
and may not work correctly.  
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
cel the warning status. The unit will be in  
the error half-reset/error reset condition.  
Contact the dealer to replace the hard  
disk.  
H-METER  
The set time for the HOUR METER has  
passed. (Refer to page 94.)  
It may be reaching the end of the hard  
disk’s lifetime.  
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
cel the warning status. The unit will be in  
the error half-reset/error reset condition.  
Contact the dealer to replace the hard  
disk.  
56  
Indication  
THERMAL  
Status  
Warning  
Description  
Solution  
Thermal error of the unit or the optional  
extension unit has been detected.  
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
cel the warning status. The unit will be in  
the error half-reset/error reset condition.  
If thermal errors occur frequently, the  
unit may be malfunctioning. Contact the  
dealer.  
POWER  
Warning  
The power outage alert signal is sup-  
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
plied from the uninterruptible power sup- cel the warning status. The unit will be in  
ply system (UPS). Internal processing the error half-reset/error reset condition.  
will start when the set time for "Shutdown The unit will start operation automatically  
Time" on the "Basic Setup" menu of  
"System" has passed after having  
received the power outage alert signal.  
(Refer to page 122.) When the internal  
processing starts, recording will stop  
and all operations will be invalid.  
after the UPS starts power supply.  
#-nn% (available  
disk space is run-  
ning out)  
#-FULL (no avail-  
able disk space)  
Error  
Warning  
The hard disk is almost full or completely Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
full.  
cel the error/warning status. The unit will  
be in the error half-reset/error reset con-  
dition. Initialize or replace the hard disk.  
(Refer to page 128, 133.) When initial-  
ized, all recorded data will be deleted. It  
is recommended to copy the data using  
an external recording device.  
The DVD-RAM disk is almost full or com- Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
pletely full.  
cel the error/warning status. The unit will  
be in the error half-reset/error reset con-  
dition. Initialize the DVD-RAM disk.  
(Refer to page 52.) When initialized, all  
recorded data will be deleted.  
The CD-R or DVD-R disk is almost full or Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
completely full.  
cel the error/warning status. The unit will  
be in the error half-reset/error reset con-  
dition. Replace the disk with a new one.  
MEDIUM-n  
Warning  
The external recording device is not  
operable because no disk or different  
format disk has been inserted, etc.  
Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
cel the warning status. The unit will be in  
the error half-reset/error reset condition.  
Confirm that a disk has been inserted, or  
check the inserted disk format.  
REMOVE  
FAN  
Error  
An error has occurred on the hard disk  
and the hard disk has been unmounted hard disk, the "REMOVE" error status will  
from the system automatically. be canceled.  
Consult the dealer. After replacing the  
Warning  
The fan of this unit or the optional exten- Press the ALARM RESET button to can-  
sion unit is malfunctioning. It may pro-  
duce an increase in temperature in the  
cel the warning status. The unit will be in  
the error half-reset condition. Consult the  
unit and cause malfunction of the HDDs. dealer.  
* : Camera number  
# : Partition number (Refer to page 14.)  
nn : Available disk space (percentage)  
n : COPY port number to which an external recording device is connected  
Note: The available disk space warning will be given only once when the available disk space has reached the set value. Mail  
notification of an available disk space warning will be sent each time 1 % of the available disk space is reduced after the  
available disk space has reached the set value. Refer to page 95 for descriptions of how to set the available disk space  
(Disk Capacity) warning. For further information about mail notification of available disk space warning, refer to the Network  
Setup Instructions (PDF).  
57  
OPERATION USING A SYSTEM CONTROLLER  
It is possible to operate this unit using a PS·Data compatible system controller.  
The following are the descriptions of how to operate this unit using the system controller WV-CU360C.  
To operate this unit using a PS·Data compatible system controller, perform the required settings in advance. Refer to a system  
administrator for further information.  
Note: To perform the operation with buttons with the shadowed background ( ), press the SHIFT button of the system con-  
troller to light the SHIFT indicator on the right side of the SHIFT button.  
Item  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
WV-CU360C  
Note  
SETUP  
SETUP  
/ESC  
Open/Close the SETUP  
MENU  
Press the button [0] to delete a character in the  
SETUP MENU.  
FUNCTION  
UP  
UP  
UP  
L
R
L
R
R
L
R
Select an item  
DOWN  
DOWN  
DOWN  
REV  
FWD  
EL-ZOOM  
+
STILL  
Rotate  
the jog  
dial  
Change the set para-  
meter  
+
CAM  
Change the cursor  
position  
SET  
SET  
SET  
CAM  
Press a button on the  
pop-up menu  
SET  
MON  
SETUP  
/ESC  
Return to the previous  
menu  
ESC  
SETUP  
Set on the SETUP  
MENU  
Summer time OFF  
Summer time ON  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Set on the SETUP  
MENU  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Set on the SETUP  
MENU  
Timer recording OFF  
Timer recording EXT  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Set on the SETUP  
MENU  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
SEARCH  
SEARCH  
SEARCH  
Display the recording  
event list  
Press the [5] button to display the search filter  
window. Press the SET button to start playback.  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Display the VMD  
search list  
Press the [5] button to display the VMD search  
list. Press the SET button to start playback.  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Display the marking list  
Press the SET button to start playback.  
Press the SET button to start playback.  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Display the menu for  
playback by designat-  
ing time and date  
SEARCH  
FUNCTION  
UP  
UP  
Move the cursor to  
search for an item  
R
L
R
Press Aor B.  
DOWN  
DOWN  
Switch displaying the  
list window and the  
thumbnail window  
alternately  
UP  
L
R
L
R
Press Cor D.  
DOWN  
REV  
FWD  
EL-ZOOM  
+
STILL  
Display a list/thumbnail  
Move the cursor to  
select  
Rotate  
the jog  
dial  
+
58  
Item  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
WV-CU360C  
Note  
MON  
SETUP  
/ESC  
Close the search win-  
dow  
Pressing the SETUP button can also close the  
search window.  
ESC  
ALM RESET  
ALARM  
RESET  
Alarm reset  
ALM RECALL  
ALM SUSPEND  
ALARM  
RESET  
+
Alarm suspension  
Manual recording  
Stop manual recording  
SET  
SETUP  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Press for 2  
seconds or  
more  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
Available only during recording  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Stop playback/manual  
recording  
Both recording and playback will be stopped if  
operating the controller as shown on the left.  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
Press the SET button to play the selected result  
from the search window.  
Play  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
STOP  
Stop playback  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
Play at normal speed  
Play at 2x speed  
Play at 5x speed  
Play at 10x speed  
Play at 20x speed  
Play at 50x speed  
Play at 100x speed  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
Reverse play at normal  
speed  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
Reverse play at 2x  
speed  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
Reverse play at 5x  
speed  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
Reverse play at 10x  
speed  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
Reverse play at 20x  
speed  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
Reverse play at 50x  
speed  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
During  
playback/  
pause  
Rotate  
the shut-  
tle ring  
Reverse play at 100x  
speed  
FUNCTION  
59  
Item  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
WV-CU360C  
Note  
SETUP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
Pause playback  
Available only during playback  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
REV  
FWD  
Rotate  
the jog-  
daial  
+
Skip to the next frame  
Available only during pause  
Available only during pause  
During  
pause  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
REV  
FWD  
Rotate  
the jog-  
daial  
Skip to the previous  
frame  
+
During  
pause  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
REV  
FWD  
The point to be skipped to will be different  
between normal playback and filtered play-  
back.  
The point to be skipped to will be different  
between normal playback and filtered play-  
back.  
Rotate  
the jog-  
daial  
+
Skip forward  
During  
playback  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
REV  
FWD  
Rotate  
the jog-  
daial  
+
Skip backward  
During  
playback  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
A-B  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
Mark start point for the  
A - B repeat playback  
REPEAT  
Available only during playback/pause  
Available only during playback/pause  
Available only during playback/pause  
Available only during playback/pause  
Available only during the filtered playback  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
A-B  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
Mark end point for the  
A - B repeat playback  
REPEAT  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
A-B  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
Cancel the A-B repeat  
playback  
REPEAT  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
Skip to the latest  
recorded image  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
IRIS  
IRIS  
LISTED  
Filtering off  
Filtering on  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
LISTED  
Mark  
Available only when it is possible to switch to  
the filtered playback  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
Mark a point  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
+
Available only during playback/pause  
Available only during playback/pause  
12  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Mark  
Mark a point  
(For the WJ-HD309)  
+
+
9
FUNCTION  
Select the normal  
recording area/event  
recording area of the  
HDD (For the WJ-  
HD316)  
SETUP  
DISK SELECT  
SHIFT  
9
7
FUNCTION  
Select the normal  
recording area/event  
recording area of the  
HDD (For the WJ-  
HD309)  
SETUP  
DISK SELECT  
SHIFT  
+
FUNCTION  
Select the copy area of  
the HDD (For the WJ-  
HD316)  
SETUP  
DISK SELECT  
DISK SELECT  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
+
+
9
7
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Select the copy area of  
the HDD (For the WJ-  
HD309)  
FUNCTION  
MON  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
Select monitor 1  
Select monitor 2  
ESC  
MON  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
ESC  
60  
Item  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
WV-CU360C  
Note  
SEQUENCE  
SEQ  
SHIFT  
Sequential display ON  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
It is possible to stop the sequential display by  
pressing a camera selection button.  
+
7
SEQUENCE  
S E Q  
SHIFT  
Sequential display ON  
(For the WJ-HD309)  
It is possible to stop the sequential display by  
pressing a camera selection button.  
+
4
CAM  
Camera  
number  
Select a camera  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
Camera selection but-  
tons (1 - 16)  
SET  
CAM  
Camera  
number  
Select a camera  
(For the WJ-HD309)  
Camera selection but-  
tons (1 - 9)  
SET  
MULTI SCREEN SELECT  
Switches in the following order each time the  
button is pressed  
Select a multi-screen  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
SHIFT  
+
1
1 - 4 CH 5 - 8 CH 9 - 12 CH 13 - 16 CH  
1 - 7 CH 1 - 9 CH 10 - 16 CH  
1 - 13 CH 1 - 16 CH  
SHIFT  
+
6
MULTI SCREEN SELECT  
Switches in the following order each time the  
button is pressed  
Select a multi-screen  
(For the WJ-HD309)  
SHIFT  
+
1
1 - 4 CH 5 - 8 CH 9 CH 1 - 7 CH  
1 - 9 CH  
SHIFT  
+
3
EL-ZOOM  
EL-ZOOM  
EL-ZOOM  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
Zooming level changes in this order:  
2x 4x 1x  
Electronic zoom  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
13  
+
+
+
EL-ZOOM  
Zooming level changes in this order:  
2x 4x 1x  
Electronic zoom  
(For the WJ-HD309)  
+
Available only during pause  
Text information display  
ON (For the WJ-HD316)  
SETUP  
TEXT  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
It is possible to turn the text information display  
off by pressing the ESC button when displaying  
text information.  
+
+
11  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
Available only during pause  
Text information display  
ON (For the WJ-HD309)  
TEXT  
It is possible to turn the text information display  
off by pressing the ESC button when displaying  
text information.  
5
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
SHIFT  
SHIFT  
COPY  
Display the DATA COPY  
menu (For the WJ-HD316)  
Available only when displaying live images or a  
list, or when pausing playback  
+
+
10/0  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
COPY  
Display the DATA COPY  
menu (For the WJ-HD309)  
Available only when displaying live images or a  
list, or when pausing playback  
8
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
SHIFT  
COPY  
Cancel copying  
(For the WJ-HD316)  
During  
copying  
+
+
10/0  
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
SHIFT  
COPY  
Cancel copying  
(For the WJ-HD309)  
During  
copying  
8
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
OSD  
SHIFT  
Switch displayed informa-  
tion (For the WJ-HD316)  
+
8
6
FUNCTION  
SETUP  
OSD  
SHIFT  
Switch displayed informa-  
tion (For the WJ-HD309)  
+
FUNCTION  
61  
OPERATION USING A PC  
It is possible to perform the settings or operate the unit  
using a web browser installed on a PC when this unit is  
connected to a network.  
The available features and the system requirements of a  
PC are as follows.  
I System Requirements of a PC  
It is recommended to operate this unit using a PC that  
meets the following system requirements. If using a PC that  
does not meet the following system requirements, it may  
cause problems such as slow imaging or the browser  
becomes unable to operate.  
Refer to the Network Operating Instructions (PDF) on the  
provided CD-ROM.  
OS:  
One of the following operating systems:  
Microsoft® Windows® 2000 Professional SP4  
Microsoft® Windows® XP Professional or Home Edition  
SP1  
I Features  
It is possible to operate this unit using a web browser in  
much the same way as using the buttons on the front panel  
of this unit.  
PC:  
The following functions are available when using a PC via a  
network as well as the functions operable using the buttons  
on the front panel of the unit.  
IBM PC/AT Compatible  
CPU:  
Intel® Pentium® 4, 1.4 GHz or faster  
Downloading/transmitting images  
Memory:  
It is possible to download (save) the currently displayed  
image in the web browser window onto the hard disk of a  
PC. By establishing an FTP server, it is possible to transmit  
images to a designated FTP server. When an event occurs,  
it is possible to transmit images from the camera installed  
in the place where the event occurred.  
512 MB or more  
Monitor:  
1024 x 768 pixels or more, HIGH colour 16 bit or more  
Interface:  
Built-in network interface card compatible 10/100 Mbps  
Recommended web browser:  
Event notification function  
Microsoft Internet Explorer 5.5SP2, 6.0 SP1  
Other web browsers are not compatible with this unit.  
When an event occurs, it is possible to send e-mails to  
designated addresses to notify of the event occurrence. It  
is also possible to send an e-mail with a recorded image of  
the place where the event occurred.  
Important:  
The plug-in software must be installed. The plug-in soft-  
ware will be downloaded and installed automatically  
when accessing the unit using a browser. If the plug-in  
software has not been downloaded/installed correctly,  
install it from the provided CD-ROM.  
Host authentication  
It is possible to restrict devices from operating this unit if  
their IP addresses are not registered.  
Refer to "readme.txt" on the provided CD-ROM for the  
descriptions of how to install it.  
62  
OPERATION OF THE UNIT IN THE CASCADE CONNECTION  
When connecting multiple units (up to 4 units) in the cascade connection, it is possible to monitor images from all of the WJ-  
HD316/309 in the cascade connection using a monitor. It is necessary in advance to perform the settings to operate the unit in  
the cascade connection. Refer to a system administrator for further information.  
I Features  
It is possible to operate the unit in the cascade connection using the buttons on the front panel in the same way as operating a  
unit used independently. Images will be displayed on monitor 2 connected to the first WJ-HD316/309. When using an optional  
PS·Data compatible controller, it is possible to operate all of the WJ-HD316/309 in the cascade connection.  
Important:  
• It is impossible to use monitor1 when connecting the units in the cascade connection. Do not operate the monitor switch  
button on the front panel after selecting "MONITOR 2" for all of the WJ-HD316/309 in the cascade connection.  
• Video output signal will not be supplied from the MONITOR (VGA) connector when connecting the units in the cascade  
connection.  
• Using the AUDIO IN and AUDIO OUT connectors on the first unit is possible. It is impossible to use the AUDIO IN and  
AUDIO OUT connectors on the second and subsequent units.  
I Operation using the buttons on the front panel  
It is possible to operate the unit using the buttons on the front panel as described on pages 19 - 57. Images will be displayed  
on monitor 2 connected to the first unit. When operating the buttons on the front panel, only live/recorded images from the  
cameras connected to the currently operated unit are available. It is impossible to operate live/recorded images from the cam-  
eras connected to the other units.  
PS·Data compatible  
system controller  
Monitor 2  
System Controller  
I Operation using a system controller  
It is possible to operate all of the WJ-HD316/309 in the cascade  
connection using an optional PS·Data compatible controller by  
designating a unit number. Refer to the operating instructions of  
the system controller or page 58 for descriptions of how to oper-  
ate a PS·Data compatible system controller.  
First unit  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
PULL  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
REV  
REV  
REV  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
FWD  
TIMER  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
ALARM  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
REPEAT  
+
ALARM  
RESET  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
Live image/  
Images can be  
HDD  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD  
HDD  
2
13  
SET  
Device to be operated recorded image/  
operated  
BUSY  
camera control  
System controller  
From any camera  
Second unit  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
PULL  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
TIMER  
From only the cam-  
eras connected to  
the first unit  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
ALARM  
SEARCH  
First unit (front panel)  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
REPEAT  
+
ALARM  
RESET  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
HDD  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD  
HDD  
2
13  
SET  
BUSY  
From only the cam-  
eras connected to  
the second unit  
Second unit (front panel)  
Third unit (front panel)  
Fourth unit (front panel)  
Third unit  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
PULL  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
From only the cam-  
eras connected to  
the third unit  
TIMER  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
ALARM  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
REPEAT  
+
ALARM  
RESET  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
HDD  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD  
From only the cam-  
eras connected to  
the fourth unit  
HDD  
2
13  
SET  
BUSY  
Fourth unit  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
PULL  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
Note: It is impossible to display images from two units of  
TIMER  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
ALARM  
SEARCH  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
the WJ-HD316/309 or more on a multi-screen.  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
REPEAT  
+
ALARM  
RESET  
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
LOGOUT  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
10/0  
14  
11  
15  
12  
16  
HDD  
1
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD  
HDD  
2
13  
SET  
BUSY  
63  
INSTALLATION IN THE RACK  
1. Remove the rubber legs (6 pcs.) on the bottom of the  
unit.  
• Use a flat-blade screwdriver and remove the screws.  
Remove the rubber legs.  
2. Install the rack mounting brackets on both sides of the  
unit.  
• Using the mounting screws (4 pcs.) for the rack mount-  
ing brackets, fix them firmly.  
Mounting screws for rack mounting brackets  
(accessories)  
Rack mounting brackets (accessories)  
3. Install the unit in the rack.  
• Fix the unit firmly with the rack mounting screws (4  
pcs.).  
Rack mounting screws  
For our rack: Nominal diameter 5 tapping (accessory)  
Important:  
• The cooling fan inside the unit is perishable and must be replaced periodically.  
• Do not block the ventilation openings or slots in the cover to prevent the unit from overheating.  
• If the rack is subject to vibration, secure the rear of the unit to the rack using additional mounting brackets (not included).  
• Keep the temperature in the rack below +45 °C (113 °F).  
• When installing, install the unit lower in the rack with a space equivalent to about 1 unit (44 mm) or more separating it from  
the other appliances.  
64  
MANAGEMENT OF USERS/HOSTS  
It is necessary in advance to register users and PCs (hosts) who access this unit via a network such as a LAN.  
Up to 32 users and 8 hosts can be registered.  
The following information can be registered as user information and host information.  
Item  
Description  
Note  
User name  
Name of user who logs into this unit. Enter this Item to be set only for user registration  
in the login window.  
Host IP address  
IP address of a PC that accesses this unit.  
Only PCs with registered IP addresses can  
access this unit if ON is selected for "Host  
Authentication".  
Item to be set only for host registration  
Item to be set only for user registration  
Password  
Level  
Password of user who logs into this unit. Enter  
this in the login window.  
Level of users or hosts for operable functions.  
Refer to page 125 for further information.  
Priority  
Priority of controllable functions. When two or  
more users/hosts performed the same opera-  
tion, only a user/host with the highest priority  
can perform the operation.  
Determine the priority in the following cases:  
• A user tries to log in after another user has  
already logged in.  
• A user tries to control a camera that is being  
controlled by another user.  
Default screen  
Startup display to be displayed on monitor 1,  
monitor 2 and the VGA monitor after login.  
Camera partitioning  
Controllable range for each camera channel.  
For the set items above, the unit will work differently depending on whether the unit is operated directly or operated via a net-  
work as follows.  
When the unit is operated directly  
Operate using the monitor connected with this unit. There are 3 ways to operate this unit as follows:  
• Operate using the buttons on the front panel of the unit  
• Operate using a PS·Data compatible controller  
Note: The priority setting of this unit will not be applied when controlling the cameras connected to the coaxial communica-  
tion using a PS·Data compatible controller. (Post-priority will be applied.)  
• Operate using a PC connected to the SERIAL connector (RS232C) on the rear panel of the unit  
It is impossible to log into the unit simultaneously by the above methods (except when using the same user name to log in).  
When a user tries to log in after another user has already logged into the unit, the unit will work as follows according to the set-  
ting for "Priority" of "System".  
Setting for "Priority"  
Description  
Follow the priority  
When a user’s priority is higher than the one of the other user  
who has already logged in, this user can log in and the other  
user who has already logged in will be forced to log out.  
When a user’s priority is lower than the one of the other user  
who has already logged in, this user cannot log in.  
Pre-priority  
Post-priority  
When another user has already logged in, any user except  
administrators cannot log in regardless of priority.  
When an administrator has logged in, the other user who has  
already logged in will be forced to log out.  
Any user can log in regardless of priority.  
65  
Notes:  
• When a user is operating this unit using a PS·Data compatible controller, this user can log in automatically as a PSD user  
set for "PSD User" of "System" on the SETUP MENU.  
• When a user logged into this unit using a PS·Data compatible controller and didn’t operate the unit for around 2 minutes,  
this PSD user will be forced to log out.  
When the unit is operated using a PC via a network  
Operate using a PC via a network. Up to 8 hosts (PCs) can access the unit.  
When a host tries to log in after 8 hosts have already logged in the unit, the unit will work as follows according to the setting for  
"Priority" of "System".  
Setting for "Priority"  
Description  
Follow the priority  
When a host’s priority is higher than the one of the other host  
who has already logged in, this host can log in and the other  
host who has already logged in will be forced to log out.  
When a host’s priority is lower than the one of the other host  
who has already logged in, this host cannot log in.  
Pre-priority  
Post-priority  
Any host cannot log in regardless of priority. However, it is  
possible to log in as an administrator by operating the but-  
tons on the front panel of the unit. In this case, users who  
have already logged in will be forced to log out.  
Any host can log in regardless of priority.  
When accessing the unit using a PC via a network, the unit will work as follows according to the setting for "User  
Authentication" and "Host Authentication" of "NW Setup 1".  
Setting for "User  
Authentication"  
Setting for "Host  
Authentication"  
User/Host to log in  
Note  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
Log into the unit as an admin-  
istrator.  
ON  
Log into the unit as a regis-  
tered user.  
The login window will be dis-  
played.  
OFF  
ON  
Log into the unit as a regis-  
tered host.  
The login window will not be  
displayed.  
ON  
Log into the unit as a regis-  
tered user.  
It is impossible to log in for  
an unregistered host.  
66  
OPERATING THE UNIT FOR THE FIRST TIME  
Important:  
v Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or  
When connecting an optional extension unit (the WJ-  
HDE300 series), turn on the power of the extension unit  
before turning on the power of this unit.  
more.  
The SETUP MENU will be displayed.  
Adjust the clock of the unit with this menu.  
Refer to page 17 for further information about clock adjust-  
ment.  
z Turn on the POWER switch.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
x Press the SET button when the system check  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
complete window is displayed.  
The HDD DISK MENU window will be displayed.  
Perform the settings with this menu according to your  
needs.  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
Refer to page 16 for further information.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
b With the default setting, the unit is ready to  
start manual recording. Perform the settings  
for recordings or event actions according to  
your needs.  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
After completing the settings, press any button to close the  
HDD DISK MENU.  
The login window will be displayed.  
When "ON" is selected for "Auto Login" of "Basic Setup" on  
the "System" menu, the login window will not be displayed.  
(The default setting is ON.)  
c Enter a user name and password.  
Live images will be displayed after logging in.  
Refer to page 16 for further information about the user  
name and password.  
Notes:  
• With the default setting, the disk space is set as the nor-  
mal recording area. Perform the settings for each  
recording area according to your needs.  
• The default user name and password are as follows:  
User name: ADMIN  
Password: 12345  
• To enhance the security, change the password for an  
administrator periodically.  
67  
v Move the cursor to "HDD Safety Mode" and  
Preparation for maintenance (HDD  
replacement, installation, etc.)  
rotate the jog dial to select "ON ".  
When maintaining (HDD replacement, installation, etc.)  
without turning the power of the unit off, carry out the follow-  
ing operation after setting the HDD SAFETY MODE to ON.  
(The default setting is ON.)  
This can be set on the "Disk Info" menu of "Maintenance".  
Refer to page 94 for further information.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
1
2
3
4
REC Rate  
Remaining  
Normal REC Area 1800GB  
Event REC Area 1200GB  
Copy Area  
Copy 1(Rear)  
Copy 2(Front)  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
MAIN  
EXT1  
EXT2  
EXT3  
EXT4  
EXT5  
EXT6  
EXT7  
Disk Info  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
1000GB  
1000GB  
1000GB  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
Event Log  
Error Log  
160GB  
15000h  
3000h  
ON  
Warning for Disk Life Time  
HDD Safety Mode  
I
I
Access Log  
Important:  
After completing the installation or the maintenance, set  
the HDD SAFETY MODE to OFF.  
b Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or  
Do the following before starting operation when maintaining  
(HDD replacement, installation, etc.).  
more.  
The SETUP MENU will be closed.  
The unit will restart automatically and the HDD SAFETY  
MODE window will be displayed.  
The HDD safety mode will begin.  
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or  
more.  
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the  
VGA monitor.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
The camera selection buttons (1 - 16 for the WJ-HD316, 1 -  
9, 0 for the WJ-HD309) will light green and orange (for 2  
seconds each) alternately.  
The following window will be displayed after around 30 sec-  
onds.  
x Select "System" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
Start maintenance after this window is displayed.  
The procedures are different between the replacement of  
the hard disks and the installation of the unit (rack mount-  
ing/unmounting).  
c Move the cursor to "Disk Info" using the  
arrows button (CD) and press the SET but-  
ton.  
Refer to the following descriptions.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
1
2
3
4
REC Rate  
Remaining  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
MAIN  
EXT1  
EXT2  
EXT3  
EXT4  
EXT5  
EXT6  
EXT7  
Normal REC Area  
Event REC Area  
Copy Area  
1800GB  
Disk Info  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
1200GB  
1000GB  
1000GB  
1000GB  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
COPY 1 (Rear)  
COPY 2 (Front)  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Warning for Disk Life Time  
HDD Safety Mode  
3000h  
OFF  
I
I
Access Log  
68  
When the system check has been completed, the HDD  
SAFETY MODE window (as shown below) will be displayed.  
The camera selection buttons on the front panel (1 - 16 for  
the WJ-HD316, 1 - 9, 0 for the WJ-HD309) will light green  
and orange (for 2 seconds each) alternately.  
The "REMOVING" indication will return to "REMOVE" by  
attaching the cable to the front panel. The power will be  
supplied to the front panel and the unit will be enabled to  
operate with the front panel.  
When replacing the built-in hard disk of the  
extension unit  
Once displaying the HDD SAFETY MODE window in step 5,  
start replacing the built-in hard disk of the optional exten-  
sion unit.  
Refer to the operating instructions of the extension unit for  
the descriptions of how to replace the hard disk.  
Move the cursor to OFF using the arrows button and press  
the SET button.  
When installing/uninstalling the unit  
into/from the rack (rack mounting/unmount-  
ing)  
Once displaying the HDD SAFETY MODE window in step 5,  
start installing/uninstalling the unit.  
The unit will restart automatically and the system check  
complete window will be displayed.  
When the system check complete window is displayed,  
carry out the procedures described on page 67 (start from  
z).  
Important:  
Detach the cable from the front panel after confirming  
that "REMOVING" is displayed. Otherwise, it may cause  
malfunction.  
When replacing the built-in hard disk of the  
unit  
Move the cursor to "REMOVE" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
The "REMOVE" indication will change to "REMOVING".  
The power supply to the front panel will be cut and the unit  
will be unable to operate with the front panel.  
Detach the cable from the front panel and start replacing  
the built-in hard disk.  
Start from step 2 on page 128 to replace the built-in hard  
disk.  
69  
CONNECTIONS  
Important  
When connecting the Panasonic matrix switcher or the data multiplex unit to this unit, the looped through output signal for  
every video input signal from them must be supplied to the video input connectors of this unit directly.  
Do not supply the monitor output signal or the spot output signal from the matrix switcher or the data multiplex unit to the video  
input connectors of this unit.  
Otherwise, the images may be disorderly displayed and recorded for a split second. (The images displayed before switching  
channel may be displayed and recorded.)  
I Connections when the unit is used independently  
An example of connections is shown below when the unit is used independently.  
Important:  
• The power plug should be connected last.  
• When connecting combination cameras, connect them to the video input connectors 1 - 8 when using the WJ-HD316 or 1 -  
6 when using the WJ-HD309 (for coaxial communication).  
Examples of connections  
Monitor 1  
Monitor 2  
Mode switch setting (Factory default)  
ON  
Microphone  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Note: If the DATA and RS485 ports are not  
used, the mode switches should be used as  
illustrated.  
Amplifier  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
4
OUT  
POWER  
AC IN  
2
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
120 V AC  
50 Hz  
For Audio Amplifier  
System cameras  
(VIDEO IN 9 - 16)  
Combination cameras  
(VIDEO IN 1 - 8)  
Notes:  
• The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA monitor. (It is impossible to display the SETUP MENU on  
monitor 1.)  
• The same images displayed on monitor 2 will be displayed on the VGA monitor.  
• Depending on the connected monitor, flickering may occur when displaying the SETUP MENU. In this case, it is rec-  
ommended to use the VGA monitor or a dirtectly connected PC using a LAN cable to perform the settings. (Refer to the  
Network Setup Instructions (PDF) for descriptions of how to connect this unit and a PC directly.)  
70  
I Connections with an extension unit  
An example of connections is shown below when the unit is used together with an optional extension unit.  
This unit can be connected with up to seven extension units.  
Connect the EXT IN port on the rear panel of the extension unit and the EXT STORAGE port on the rear panel of this unit using  
the cable provided with the optional extension unit.  
Important:  
Use the cable provided with the optional extension unit.  
Fix the cables with the cable clamp (provided with each unit) to prevent disconnection or unstable connections that may  
cause recording failures or an unstable system.  
How to fix the cable clamp  
Cable Clamp  
Fixing screw  
A  
Remove this screw from the  
unit and fix the cables with the  
cable clamp using the provided  
screw for the cable clamp.  
G
E
1
2
1
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
This unit  
Cable (attached to the extension unit)  
SIGNAL GND  
POWER  
AC IN  
EXT  
IN  
OUT  
2
1
Extension unit (WJ-HDE300 series)  
Cable Clamp  
EXT  
Fixing screw  
IN  
OUT  
Remove this screw from the  
unit and fix the cables with the  
cable clamp using the provided  
screw for the cable clamp.  
2
1
How to fix the cable clamp  
71  
I Connections with DVD-RAM, CD-R, and DVD-R drives  
This is an example of connection when the unit is used together with the designated DVD-RAM, DVD-R and CD-R drive.  
Connect the designated DVD-RAM, DVD-R and CD-R drive and the COPY1 port on the rear panel or the COPY2 port inside the  
connectors cover on the front panel of this unit using an USB cable (not included).  
Important:  
Use an appropriate USB cable compatible with the USB2.0 standard.  
Fix the cables with the cable clamp (provided with this unit) to prevent disconnection or unstable connections that may  
cause recording failures or an unstable system.  
Designated DVD-RAM drive, etc.  
R
O
M
How to fix the cable clamp  
Cable Clamp  
USB cable (Locally procured)  
Fixing screw  
Y  
/
Remove this screw from the  
RA  
2
GE  
1
unit and fix the cables with the  
cable clamp using the provided  
screw for the cable clamp.  
1
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
Rear  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
TIMER  
S-VIDEO  
1
2
3
4
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
SEARCH  
ALARM  
VIDEO  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
COPY  
2
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
OUT  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
5
9
6
7
8
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
REPEAT  
ALARM  
RESET  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
12  
10/0  
11  
AUDIO  
OUT  
HDD 1  
HDD 2  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
Front  
USB cable (Locally procured)  
R
O
M
Designated DVD-RAM drive, etc.  
72  
I Connections with the VTR  
When it is necessary to copy the recorded images to a video tape using a VTR, connect the VTR to the S-VIDEO connector (or  
the VIDEO OUT connector) and the AUDIO OUT connector inside the connectors cover on the front panel of this unit as below.  
Open the connectors cover.  
STOP  
PLAY  
PAUSE  
REC  
-
REC STOP  
MONITOR1  
MONITOR2  
REV  
FWD  
TIMER  
S-VIDEO  
1
5
2
6
3
7
4
8
PAN/  
TILT  
GOTO  
LAST  
ERROR  
SEARCH  
ALARM  
VIDEO  
SHIFT  
SEQ  
OSD  
COPY  
2
SETUP  
/ESC  
PAN/TILT  
SLOW  
OUT  
ZOOM/  
FOCUS  
A-B  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
REPEAT  
ALARM  
RESET  
+
DISK SELECT  
EL-ZOOM  
COPY  
TEXT  
MARK  
IRIS  
LISTED  
9
12  
10/0  
11  
AUDIO  
OUT  
HDD 1  
HDD 2  
PRESET  
/AUTO  
OPERATE  
LOGOUT  
SET  
13  
14  
15  
16  
BUSY  
AUDIO  
IN  
Audio cable with an RCA pin plug (Locally procured)  
Audio cable with an RCA pin plug (Locally procured)  
VTR  
VIDEO  
IN  
S-VIDEO IN  
connector  
S-video cable (Locally procured)  
Note: The same video signal supplied to the MONITOR1 connector and to the MONITOR2 (VGA) connector will be supplied to  
the S-VIDEO connector and the VIDEO OUT connector inside the connectors cover.  
The same audio signal supplied to the AUDIO OUT connector on the rear panel of this unit will be supplied to the AUDIO  
OUT connector inside the connectors cover on the front panel.  
73  
I Connections with PS·Data systems  
This is an example of connection when the unit is used together with the PS·Data devices.  
If a connected system controller is PS·Data compatible, it is possible to operate this unit or connected devices using the sys-  
tem controller.  
Use the RS485 cable provided with the system controller.  
Important:  
Terminate both devices on both ends of the connection. Refer to the respective operating instructions for the descriptions  
of how to terminate. Termination of this unit can be set with the mode switch on the rear panel. (See below.)  
When connecting a PS·Data compatible device, it is necessary to set each item of "PS·Data Setup" of "Comm" on the  
SETUP MENU according to the system configuration.  
The PS·Data is our exclusive protocol. Contact the dealer about devices that can be connected.  
When connecting this unit with a controller  
System Controller  
RS485 cable (provided with the controller)  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: ON)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
Controller  
Termination: ON  
Unit Address : 1  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
2
POWER  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
15  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
AC IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
"PS·Data setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU  
Unit Address (System) : 1  
Unit Address (Controller) : 2  
74  
When installing this unit between a controller and a system device  
System Controller  
RS485 cable  
UNIT  
0
ALARM  
RESET  
POWER  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
SUSPEND  
SET  
SET UP  
4
5
ALARM  
ESC  
ON  
1
2
3
OFF  
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204  
Coaxial communication unit  
Termination: ON  
Unit Address : 2  
Controller  
Termination: ON  
Unit Address : 1  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Mode switch  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
2
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
"PS·Data setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU  
Unit Address (System) : 1  
Unit Address (Controller) : 2  
When connecting this unit with a system device  
RS485 cable  
UNIT  
0
ALARM  
RESET  
POWER  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
SUSPEND  
SET  
SET UP  
4
5
ALARM  
ESC  
ON  
1
2
3
OFF  
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204  
Coaxial communication unit  
Termination: ON  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: ON)  
Unit Address : 3  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
RS485 cable  
MODE  
2
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
UNIT  
0
ALARM  
RESET  
OUT  
POWER  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
SUSPEND  
SET  
SET UP  
4
5
ALARM  
ESC  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
ON  
VIDEO  
1
2
3
OFF  
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204  
Coaxial communication unit  
Termination: OFF  
Unit Address : 2  
"PS·Data setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU  
Unit Address (System) : 1  
Unit Address (Controller) : 1  
75  
I Cascade connection of multiple units  
Up to of four units can be connected.  
For the cascade connection, connect the CASCADE IN connector and the CASCADE OUT connector on the rear panel of each  
unit as below.  
Important:  
When connecting the unit in the cascade connection, set "Cascade" of "PS·Data Setup" in "Comm" on the SETUP MENU to  
"ON". (Page 116)  
It is impossible to use this connector when connecting the unit in the cascade connection.  
When no PS·Data compatible device is connected to the system  
Monitor 2  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: ON)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Unit Address settings  
of "PS·Data Setup"  
of "Comm" on the  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
SETUP MENU  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
First unit (this unit)  
System : 1  
Controller : 1  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
RS485 Cable  
Mode switch  
ON  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
2
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
Second unit  
System : 2  
Controller : 2  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
RS485 Cable  
Mode switch  
ON  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
(No. 7: ON)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
Third unit  
System : 3  
Controller : 3  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
76  
When the PS·Data compatible device is connected to the first unit  
Controller  
Termination: ON  
Unit Address : 1  
Monitor 2  
System Controller  
RS485 cable  
(provided with  
Mode switch  
the controller)  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Unit Address settings  
of "PS·Data Setup"  
of "Comm" on the  
SETUP MENU  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITR OUT CASCDE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
First unit (this unit)  
System : 1  
Controller : 2  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
RS485 cable  
Mode switch  
ON  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
2
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
Second unit  
System : 2  
Controller : 3  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
RS485 cable  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: ON)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
2
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
Third unit  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
System : 3  
Controller : 4  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
77  
When the PS·Data compatible device is connected to the third unit  
Monitor 2  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: ON)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Unit Address settings  
of "PS·Data Setup"  
of "Comm" on the  
SETUP MENU  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
First unit (this unit)  
System : 1  
Controller : 1  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
RS485 cable  
Mode switch  
ON  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
2
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
Second unit  
System : 2  
Controller : 2  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
RS485 cable  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
2
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
Third unit  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
System : 3  
Controller : 3  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
Coaxial communication unit  
Termination: ON  
Unit Address: 4  
UNIT  
0
ALARM  
RESET  
POWER  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
SUSPEND  
SET  
SET UP  
ESC  
5
ALARM  
ON  
1
2
3
4
OFF  
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204  
RS485 cable  
78  
When the PS·Data compatible devices are connected to the first and third units  
·
PS Data Compatible  
System Controller  
Monitor 2  
Controller  
Termination: ON  
Unit Address: 1  
RS485 cable  
(provided with  
the controller)  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Unit Address settings  
of "PS·Data Setup"  
of "Comm" on the  
SETUP MENU  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
First unit (this unit)  
System : 1  
Controller : 2  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
RS485 cable  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
Mode switch  
ON  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
2
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
Second unit  
System : 2  
Controller : 3  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
BNC Cable  
(Locally procured)  
RS485 cable  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 7: OFF)  
(No. 8: OFF)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
Third unit  
System : 3  
Controller : 4  
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
UNIT  
0
ALARM  
RESET  
POWER  
ALARM  
SUSPEND  
Coaxial communication unit  
Termination: ON  
Unit Address: 5  
SUSPEND  
SET  
SET UP  
4
ALARM  
ESC  
ON  
1
2
3
OFF  
RS485 cable  
Data Multiplex Unit WJ-MP204  
79  
I Connection with the RS485 camera  
This is an example of connection when the unit is used together with the RS485 devices.  
Up to eight cameras can be connected using a single RS485 (CAMERA) port.  
Important:  
Terminate both devices on both ends of the connection. Refer to the respective operating instructions for the descriptions  
of how to terminate. Termination of this unit can be set with the mode switch on the rear panel.  
When connecting an RS485 camera, it is necessary to set each item of "RS485 Setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP MENU  
according to the RS485 settings of the camera. (Refer to page 117.)  
The total length of the RS485 cable from this unit is 1 200 meters at the maximum.  
1:1 connection  
Connect a camera to the RS485 (CAMERA) port.  
Example: When the RS485 cameras are connected to the CAMERA IN connectors 9 and 13:  
Mode switch  
ON  
(No. 1, No. 4 : ON)  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1
SIGNAL GND  
4
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
SERIAL  
ALARM  
CASCADE  
OUT  
3
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
PS·DATA  
5
RS-485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXIT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
9
7
7
6
6
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
8
5
4
2
1
CAMERA  
RS485 cable  
RS485 cable  
Unit No.13  
Termination: ON  
Unit No.9  
Termination: ON  
Combination Cameras  
Connect the RS485 camera to Switches required to be set  
4-wire communication  
2-wire communication  
No.2  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
RS485 (1)  
No.3  
No.5  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
RS485 (2)  
No.6  
80  
Daisy connection  
Multiple cameras can be connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port.  
Example: When cameras 1 - 4 are connected to one of the RS485 (CAMERA) port and cameras 9 - 12 are connected to the  
other RS485 (CAMERA) port.  
RS485 cable  
Mode switch  
ON  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Nos. 1,2,3,4,5,6 : ON  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
2
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
15  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
Unit No. 12 Unit No. 11 Unit No. 10 Unit No. 9  
Termination: Termination: Termination: Termination:  
ON OFF OFF OFF  
Unit No. 4  
Unit No. 3  
Unit No. 2  
Unit No. 1  
Termination: Termination: Termination: Termination:  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
Connect the RS485 camera to Switches required to be set  
4-wire communication  
2-wire communication  
No.2  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
RS485 (1)  
No.3  
No.5  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
RS485 (2)  
No.6  
81  
I Mode Switch  
RS485 interface is used to communicate between this unit and the PS·Data compatible system device. In this case, it is neces-  
sary to terminate both devices on both ends of the RS485 connection.  
The settings of the mode switch will be different depending on whether this unit is used as a receiver or a controller.  
When an RS 485 camera is connected to this unit, it is necessary to terminate both devices on both ends of the connection.  
When connecting this unit with the system controller and  
this is installed at the end of the PS·Data connection  
PS·Data termination switch 1: ON  
RS485 (1) terminating switch  
RS485 (1) 2/4-wire changeover  
RS485 (2) terminating switch  
When connecting a system device and this unit is installed  
at the end of the PS·Data connection  
PS·Data terminating switch 2: ON  
RS485 (2) 2/4-wire changeover  
PSData terminating switch 1  
PSData terminating switch 2  
When connecting RS485 cameras  
Set the termination switch of the connected RS485 (CAMERA)  
port to ON.  
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 1: Set the RS485 (1)  
termination switch to ON.  
ON  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 2: Set the RS485 (2)  
termination switch to ON.  
For 2-wire communication  
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 1: Set the switch No.2 and No.3 to ON.  
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 2: Set the switch No.5 and No.6 to ON.  
For 4-wire communication  
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 1: Set the switch No.2 and No.3 to OFF.  
Connected to the RS485 (CAMERA) port 2: Set the switch No.5 and No.6 to OFF.  
I RS485 Port  
Internal block diagram  
RA  
RB  
DATA  
TA  
TB  
G
N
D
G
N
D
TA TB RA RB  
Output Input  
82  
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM/CONTROL Connector  
These terminals are used for emergency recording, auto time adjustment (Auto Adjust Time), taking measures against power  
outages (Shutdown Time), and when installing a buzzer, a lamp, or similar alarm device. They are also used to synchronize  
with the sequential display changeover.  
The terminal pin array and connections are shown below. The  
connector used should be compatible with the pin configuration.  
!
q
Pin array  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
The pin array is different from other disk recorders. Make sure that  
the connection is correct referring to the following.  
@
!
Pin No.  
Signal  
Operation  
Remarks  
Ch 8 alarm output  
Ch 9 alarm output  
Ch 10 alarm output  
Ch 11 alarm output  
Ch 12 alarm output  
Ch 13 alarm output  
Ch 14 alarm output  
Ch 15 alarm output  
Ch 16 alarm output  
NC  
q
w
e
r
t
y
u
i
o
!
!
Alarm signal output at an event occurrence  
Open collector output  
24 V max., 100 mA  
Only for the WJ-HD316  
(Not available for the WJ-HD309)  
Alarm reset input  
Canceling the alarm display  
Non-voltage make contact input  
100 mA, 5 V pull-up  
Emergency recording  
input  
Starting emergency recording disk space a sig-  
nal input  
!
Earth (Grounding)  
!, !  
Alarm output for available  
disk space of device con-  
nected to copy port  
Generation of signal output for disk space alarm- Open collector output  
!
ing of DVD-RAM, DVD-R and CD-R  
24 V max., 100 mA  
Signal output upon detection of an HDD error  
Signal output upon detection of a camera error  
Signal output upon detection of a unit error  
HDD error output  
Camera error output  
Error output  
!
!
!
End of outage process-  
ing  
Signal output upon completion of outage pro-  
cessing  
High (+12 V)  
!
The time of this unit is adjusted to the preset time  
30 k5 V pull-up,  
according to the signal input. This signal output is 100 mA/make contact  
then generated for the setting time of this unit.  
Time of all other units is adjusted to the setting  
time of this unit.  
Time adjustment I/O  
@
Sequence changeover is affected according to  
the signal input. Signal output is generated at the  
time of sequence changeover.  
Sequence changeover  
I/O  
@
The state of alarm suspension is assumed  
according to the signal input.  
Alarm suspension input  
Outage detection I/O  
@
@
Start of outage processing according to the sig-  
nal input.  
Non-voltage make contact input  
100 mA/5 V pull-up  
External recording mode  
changeover  
Changeover to the external recording mode  
+5 V output  
@
@
+5 V output  
200 mA max.  
83  
Connection for emergency recording  
When the external switch is turned ON, emergency recording will be started.  
Resolution, recording time, recording rate and quality for emergency recording can differ according to the settings of  
"Emergency REC" of "Recording" on the SETUP MENU. (Refer to page 99.)  
(Earth)  
(Emergency record input)  
!
!
External switch  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
Connection for external recording changeover  
When the external switch is turned ON, the recording program changeover is affected for recording.  
The recording program can be set for "EXT." with the "Time Table" of "Schedule" on the SETUP MENU. (Refer to page 108.)  
(Earth)  
(External recording mode)  
!
@
External switch  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
Connection to synchronize the sequential display changeover (when multiple  
units are used)  
Sequential display changeover is affected by the timing of supplied signals to the sequence changeover input terminal. When  
multiple units are used, the sequence timing can be synchronized.  
Setting for the sequence timing can be set with "Sequence Timing" of "Switcher" on the SETUP MENU. (Refer to page 111.)  
For the synchronization of the sequence timing between multiple units, there is a difference in the sequence timing setting as  
shown below between the synchronized side (Master) and the synchronizing side (Slave).  
Synchronized side (Master): Set at "INT" (functioning as an output terminal)  
Synchronizing side (Slave): Set at "EXT" (functioning as an input terminal)  
(Earth)  
(Earth)  
(Sequence changeover input)  
(Sequence changeover output)  
!
!
@
@
ALARM/CONTOROL  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
(First unit)  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
(Second unit)  
84  
Connection for the Auto Adjust Time function  
When "Auto Adjust Time" of "System" on the SETUP MENU is set to "MASTER"  
"Time Adjust Output" becomes available and the clock of this unit can be applied to other units.  
Terminal block of other units  
Front LED  
(Earth)  
(Time adjust output)  
monitor  
output  
!
@
ALARM/CONTOROL  
When "Auto Adjust Time" of "System" on the SETUP MENU is set to "SLAVE"  
"Time Adjust Input" becomes available. When a signal output from other equipment is supplied to the time adjust I/O terminals  
between 00 minutes 00 seconds and 14 minutes 59 seconds every hour or between 45 minutes 00 seconds and 59 minutes  
59 seconds every hour, the clock will be set to "00 minutes 00 seconds" of the closest hour.  
Example:  
Signal is supplied at 2:50:00 (hour:minute:second)pm Set at 3:00:00 pmM  
Signal input supplied at 3:14:45 pm Set at 3:00:00 pm  
Signal is supplied at 3:20:00 pm Time will not be adjusted.  
Terminal block of other units  
Front LED  
(Earth)  
(Time adjust output)  
monitor  
output  
!
@
ALARM/CONTOROL  
Important:  
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds when changing the present time (accurate within 5 seconds) using  
the time adjustment input (pin no.20).  
85  
Connection with the Uninterruptible Power System (UPS)  
This is an example of connection with the uninterruptible power system (UPS) to be installed to protect from a power outage.  
When a signal is supplied to the outage detection I/O terminals from the uninterruptible power system (UPS), internal process-  
ing (stops recording safely) will be started to shut off the power supply for this unit.  
After completing the internal processing, a signal will be supplied from the outage processing end output terminal to the unin-  
terruptible power system (UPS). Then, the power supply to this unit can be suspended.  
(GND)  
(C O M )  
(Detection)  
(Shutdown)  
(Outage detection I/O)  
(Outage processing end output)  
* Refer to the operating  
instructions of the used  
product for further  
This unit  
information about  
connection of the UPS side.  
!
@
!
Uninterruptible  
power system  
(UPS)  
Power cable  
To an AC outlet  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
Connection of the control output  
When an alarm device such as a buzzer or a lamp is connected, the signal output from Pin Nos. 15 - 18 can be used to  
notify the status by sounding a buzzer or lighting a lamp.  
The following example is of a connection with the HDD error output (pin no. 16).  
(GND)  
(HDD error output)  
!
!
Alarming device  
Relay, etc.  
Install according  
to your needs  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
86  
I How to Use the Terminals of the ALARM Connector  
These terminals are used to connect the alarm devices, such as sensors, door switches, etc.  
The pin configurations of these terminals are as shown below. The connector used should be compatible with the pin configu-  
ration.  
Pin Configuration  
!
q
ALARM  
@
!
The pin array is different from other disk recorders. Make sure that the connection is correct by referring to the following.  
Pin No.  
q
Signal  
Ch 1 alarm input  
Ch 2 alarm input  
Ch 3 alarm input  
Ch 4 alarm input  
Ch 5 alarm input  
Ch 6 alarm input  
Ch 7 alarm input  
Ch 8 alarm input  
Ch 1 alarm output  
Ch 2 alarm output  
Ch 3 alarm output  
Ch 4 alarm output  
Earth (Grounding)  
Ch 9 alarm input  
Ch 10 alarm input  
Ch 11 alarm input  
Ch 12 alarm input  
Ch 13 alarm input  
Ch 14 alarm input  
Ch 15 alarm input  
Ch 16 alarm input  
Ch 5 alarm output  
Ch 6 alarm output  
Ch 7 alarm output  
Operation  
Remarks  
Event action will be performed according  
to the settings.  
Non-voltage make contact/100 mA,  
w
5 V pull-up  
e
r
t
y
u
i
o
Alarm signal will be supplied at an event  
occurrence  
Open collector output/24 V, 100 mA  
!
!
!
!, !  
!
Event action will be performed according  
to the setting.  
Non-voltage make contact input/  
100 mA, 5 V pull-up  
!
!
!
Only for the WJ-HD316  
(Not available for the WJ-HD309)  
!
@
@
@
@
Alarm signal will be supplied at an event  
occurrence  
Open collector output/24 V max.,  
100 mA  
@
@
87  
Alarm connection  
When a signal is supplied to the alarm input terminals of CH 1-16, recording and displaying of camera images will be per-  
formed according to the settings.  
When an alarm device such as a buzzer, a lamp, etc., is installed outside, connect them to the alarm output terminals (pin nos.  
9 - 12, pin nos. 23 - 25) or to the alarm output terminals (pin nos. 1 - 9) of the ALARM/CONTROL terminal.  
Sensor  
Security door  
switch  
(GND)  
!
o
!
q
Alarming devices  
Relay, etc.  
@
Install according to  
your needs.  
ALARM  
(Ch 1 alarm output)  
(GND)  
!
o
Alarming devices  
Relay, etc.  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
Install according to  
your needs.  
(Ch 16 alarm output)  
Time and polarities of the ALARM/CONTROL terminal and the ALARM terminal  
Terminal  
Active time  
Note  
Alarm input  
100 ms or more  
N.O.: L active  
N.C.: H active  
Alarm output  
The set time on the SETUP MENU  
100 ms or more  
L active  
L active  
L active  
L active  
Alarm reset input  
Emergency recording input  
100 ms or more  
Alarm output for available disk space of While the size of the available disk  
device connected to the copy port  
space is less than the set size  
Until the HDD error is cleared  
Until the camera error is cleared  
Until the error is cleared  
100 ms  
HDD error output  
L active  
L active  
L active  
H active  
L active  
Camera error output  
Error output  
Outage processing end output  
Time adjust I/O  
Input: 100 ms or more  
Output: 1 s  
Sequence changeover output  
Outage detection output  
100 ms or more  
100 ms or more  
100 ms or more  
100 ms or more  
L active  
L active  
External recording mode changeover  
Alarm suspend output  
L active, judged by level  
L active, judged by level  
88  
I How to Use the SERIAL Connector  
This connector is compliant with the RS232C Standard, and is used to communicate with a connected PC.  
A connection example and the pin configuration of the SERIAL connector are as shown below.  
Important:  
When using the SERIAL connector, it is necessary to perform the settings with "RS232C Setup" of "Comm" on the SETUP  
MENU for the communication functions. (Page 118)  
Pin Configuration  
Serial connector of this unit  
D-sub Pin 9 (Female)  
Personal computer side  
D-sub Pin 9 (Female)  
(Locally procured)  
7 (RTS)  
7 (RTS)  
8 (CTS)  
3 (TXD)  
5 (GND)  
2 (RXD)  
8 (CTS)  
3 (TXD)  
5 (GND)  
2 (RXD)  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
PC or another device  
Connection example of cross cable  
Connection example  
D-sub Pin 9  
(Female)  
D-sub Pin 9  
(Female)  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
2
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
15  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
PC  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
This unit  
89  
SETUP  
To operate this unit, it is necessary to set each item of the SETUP MENU in advance.  
Perform the settings for each item of the SETUP MENU by displaying the SETUP MENU on monitor 2.  
Settings items are as below.  
I Item list of the SETUP MENU  
Settings menu  
Maintenance  
Description  
Page  
REC Rate  
Display the recording rate for each recording mode and image quality for each  
camera channel in list form.  
94  
94  
94  
95  
95  
95  
Disk Info  
Display hard disk information such as the available disk space on the built-in hard  
disk and the connected optional extension unit.  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
Display version information of the software and the hardware and the MAC  
address.  
Set actions to be taken when the available space of the built-in hard disk or of the  
connected external recording device reaches a specified level.  
Set to display a warning when the available space of the built-in hard disk or of the  
connected external recording device reaches a specified level.  
Delete data stored on the hard disk, or format (initialize) the DVD-RAM disk con-  
nected to the COPY port.  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Display the event log. Refer to page 44 for further information.  
Display the error log such as a HDD error log.  
96  
96  
97  
Access Log  
Display the time, user name and IP addresses when logging in/out to/from this  
unit.  
Recording  
REC Setup  
Perform the basic settings for recording.  
98  
99  
Emergency REC  
Perform the settings for emergency recording such as recording time and record-  
ing rate.  
Event  
Event Setup  
Perform the settings for the alarm output duration and the buzzer sound when an  
event (motion detection, video loss, command/terminal alarm) occurs.  
100  
100  
VMD Setup  
Perform the settings for the motion detection area, sensitivity and the detection  
mode for each camera channel.  
Alarm Setup  
Perform the settings for the alarm display duration and alarm suspension duration.  
Specify the alarm terminal polarity.  
103  
104  
Terminal Setup  
Schedule  
Time Table  
Create timetables for each day of the week, and assign the recording action pro-  
grams and event action programs to the created timetables.  
108  
REC Program  
Up to 4 recording programs can be created. Perform the settings for the recording  
actions for each program such as image quality and recording rate for each cam-  
era channel.  
105  
107  
109  
Event Program  
Special Days  
Up to 4 event programs can be created. Perform the settings for each program  
such as the event action and the auto copy function for each event type.  
Assign timetables independently for special days aside from other days.  
90  
Description  
Page  
Settings menu  
Switcher  
Monitor1  
Perform the settings for the image switching on monitor 1 such as the setting of  
the sequential display or the screen to be displayed at login on monitor 1.  
110  
112  
Monitor 2  
Display  
Perform the settings for the image switching on monitor 2 such as the setting of  
the sequential display or the screen to be displayed at login on monitor 2.  
OSD Setup  
Monitor1  
Monitor2  
Perform the display settings such as the settings for the display position of the  
camera title and the time.  
113  
114  
115  
Perform the display settings for monitor 1 such as the camera title display on/off,  
the alarm display on/off and the time display on/off.  
Perform the display settings for monitor 2 such as the display mode (task bar  
style), the camera title display position, and the camera title display on/off.  
Comm  
Camera Control  
Set the communication type to control cameras for each camera channel.  
116  
116  
PS·Data Setup  
Perform the settings for the PS·Data. It is necessary to perform these settings  
when connecting an external device such as a controller to the DATA port on the  
rear panel of this unit.  
RS485 Setup  
RS232C Setup  
NW Setup 1  
NW Setup 2  
NTP Setup  
Perform the settings for the RS485. It is necessary to perform these settings when  
connecting an RS 485 compatible camera to the RS485 (CAMERA) port on the  
rear panel of this unit.  
117  
118  
119  
Perform the settings for the SERIAL (RS232C). It is necessary to perform these  
settings when connecting a PC to the SERIAL connector on the rear panel of this  
unit.  
Perform the basic network settings. It is necessary to perform these settings when  
operating this unit via a network such as a LAN. The settings for the user authenti-  
cation and the host authentication can also be set with these settings.  
Perform the network connection settings such as IP addresses and the gateway  
address. It is necessary to perform these settings when operating this unit via a  
network such as a LAN.  
119  
120  
Perform the NTP server settings such as the NTP server address and the time  
zone setting. It is necessary to synchronize the clock with the NTP server.  
System  
Basic Setup  
Time & Date  
User Regist.  
Perform the settings for the basic operation of this unit.  
121  
122  
123  
Perform the settings for the time adjustment and display of the time and date.  
Perform the settings for the user registration and the user authentication such as  
user name, password and operational level.  
User Edit  
Edit the registered user information.  
Delete registered users.  
124  
124  
124  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Register the hosts (PCs access this unit via a network) with their information such  
as IP address and operational level for the host authentication.  
Host Edit  
Edit the registered hosts.  
125  
125  
125  
126  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
Delete the registered hosts.  
Perform the settings to specify operable functions for each level.  
The set contents can be saved or loaded.  
Note: Refer to page 127 for further information about the settings using the setup menu of camera.  
91  
I About the SETUP MENU  
Main menu  
Live image  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Switcher  
Display  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM 1  
CAM 2  
CAM 3  
CAM 4  
CAM 5  
CAM 6  
CAM 7  
CAM 8  
CAM 9  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
Main area  
Submenu  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
Main menu: These menus are always displayed on the SETUP MENU.  
Live image: Live images from the camera channel that was selected just before the SETUP MENU was displayed.  
Main area: The setting items of the selected submenu will be displayed in this area.  
Submenu: The submenu of the selected main menu will be displayed on the left side of the SETUP MENU. The submenus dif-  
fer depending on the selected main menu.  
Notes:  
The SETUP MENU will be displayed on monitor 2 and the VGA monitor. (It is impossible to display the SETUP MENU on  
monitor 1.)  
The same images displayed on monitor 2 will be displayed on the VGA monitor.  
Depending on the connected monitor, flickering may occur when displaying the SETUP MENU. In this case, it is recom-  
mended to use the VGA monitor or a dirtectly connected PC using a LAN cable to perform the settings. (Refer to the  
Network Setup Instructions (PDF) for descriptions of how to connect this unit and a PC directly.)  
92  
I Basic Operation with the SETUP MENU  
z Press the SETUP/ESC button for 2 seconds or more  
v Perform the settings for each item.  
when displaying live images.  
Item selection: Move the cursor using the arrows but-  
ton (C D A B).  
[Screenshot 1]  
Change the setting: Rotate the jog dial.  
The top page of the SETUP MENU will be displayed.  
Pop-up display of the setting item: Press the SET but-  
ton when the setting item has the "SETUP" button  
next to the item name.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
Turning pages of the settings menu: When "PREV/  
NEXT PAGE" is displayed on the bottom of the set-  
tings menu, move the cursor to the "PREV/NEXT  
PAGE" using the arrows button, and then use the  
arrows button (AB) to turn the pages.  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Selecting a submenu again: Press the SET button.  
The cursor will be able to select a submenu again.  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
x Select a main menu using the arrows button and press  
the SET button.  
b After completing the settings, press the SETUP/ESC  
button for 2 seconds or more to apply the settings. The  
SETUP MENU will be closed.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The submenu of the selected main menu will be displayed.  
Live images will be displayed again.  
Important:  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
If the settings are changed, all login users will be  
forcibly logged out.  
ON  
OFF  
All  
REC Setup  
Recording  
Power ON Manual REC  
Manual Recording Channel  
Embedded REC(Title)  
Embedded REC(Time&Date)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
Emergency REC  
ON  
ON  
REC Priority  
PRIORITY  
REC MODE  
Manual REC  
Event REC  
1
2
3
Schedule REC  
Audio Allocation  
AUDIO  
I
CAMERA  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
Audio1  
Audio2  
Audio3  
Audio4  
c Select the submenu using the arrows button (CD) and  
the press the SET button.  
When selecting the submenu by the cursor is enabled,  
press the SETUP/ESC button. The main menu can be  
selected.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The setting items will be displayed in the main area and the  
cursor will move to a setting item.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
REC Setup  
Resolution  
Recording Time  
Recording Rate and Quality  
FIELD  
10s  
I
I
I
Emergency REC  
RATE  
Quality  
RATE  
Quality  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
SFA CAM9  
SFA CAM10  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
CAM11  
SFA  
SFA CAM12  
SFA CAM13  
SFA CAM14  
SFA CAM15  
SFA CAM16  
Auto Copy  
OFF  
I
93  
I [Maintenance] Functions for Maintaining  
Perform the settings for the hard disk drives.  
It is possible to check the histories (log) of event occur-  
rence, error occurrence and access.  
Notes:  
The displayed available disk space on this menu  
will not include the space required for data man-  
agement. Therefore, the understated available disk  
space will be displayed.  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
When CONTINUE is selected for "Disk End Mode" of  
"Maintenance", available disk space will be dis-  
played as "--".  
"**" will be displayed to refer to a disk that is not  
connected or a non-existent area on the disk.  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
8Warning for Disk Life Time (hour meter warning  
setting)  
Select the duration as the maximum active time of the hard  
disk from the following. A warning will be displayed when  
the set time have passed. Hard disk drives will need to be  
replaced after around 20 000 - 30 000 hours of operation in  
case they are used at temperature of 25°C (77 °F). (Refer to  
page 5.)  
[REC Rate] Check the recording rate and  
the image quality for each camera channel.  
The recording rate for each recording mode for each cam-  
era (as shown below) will be displayed in list form.  
10 000 h/20 000 h/30 000 h  
SET UP MENU Maintenance Recording  
Switcher Display  
Event  
Schedule  
System  
LIVE  
Comm  
MANU  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SCHE PRE EVT POST EVT EMR  
REC Rate  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
CAM  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
8HDD Safety Mode  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Date Delete  
When maintaining (HDD replacement, installation, etc.)  
without turning the power of the unit off, select ON for "HDD  
Safety Mode". The unit will be restarted in the HDD Safety  
Mode. Refer to page 68 for further information.  
(The default setting is ON.)  
CAM 10  
CAM 11  
CAM 12  
CAM 13  
CAM 14  
CAM 15  
CAM 16  
Event Log  
Error Log  
SUPER FINE  
FINE  
Access Log  
NORMAL  
EXTENDED  
MANU: Manual recording  
SCHE: Schedule recording  
PRE EVT: Pre-event recording  
POST EVT: Post-event recording  
EMR: Emergency recording  
[Version Info] Check the version information  
Version information of the software and the hardware, and  
the MAC address will be displayed.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
REC Rate  
[Disk Info] Check the available hard disk  
Software  
Hardware (M)  
(V)  
Mac Address  
V1.00  
V1.00  
V1.00  
I
Disk Info  
I
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
AA-BB-CC-DD-EE-FF  
space  
I
The available hard disk space of the following will be dis-  
played: The built-in hard disk (normal recording area, event  
recording area and copy area), optional extension unit  
(EXT1 - 7), DVD-RAM, CD-R and DVD-R disk drive connect-  
ed to the copy port (COPY1 or COPY2).  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
Refer to page 25 for more details on the built-in hard disk.  
It is also possible to perform the settings for the hour-meter  
(the active time of the HDD) warning and for the HDD safety  
mode with this menu.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
1
2
3
4
REC Rate  
Remaining  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
MAIN  
EXT1  
EXT2  
EXT3  
EXT4  
EXT5  
EXT6  
EXT7  
Normal REC Area  
Event REC Area  
Copy Area  
1800GB  
Disk Info  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
160GB  
15000h  
1200GB  
1000GB  
1000GB  
1000GB  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
COPY 1 (Rear)  
COPY 2 (Front)  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Warning for Disk Life Time  
HDD Safety Mode  
3000h  
OFF  
I
I
Access Log  
94  
Important:  
When "CONTINUE" is selected for "Disk End Mode", a  
[Disk End Mode] Set actions to be taken  
when the available hard disk space has run  
out  
warning will not be issued.  
Select an action from the following to be taken when the  
available space of the built-in hard disk (normal recording  
area, event recording area, copy area) or the external  
recording device (DVD-RAM, CD-R or DVD-R disk drive)  
connected to the copy port (COPY1, COPY2) is running  
out.  
[Data Delete] Delete image data on the hard  
disk  
Delete image data on the built-in hard disk (normal record-  
ing area/event recording area).  
Auto deletion and manual deletion are available to delete  
image data.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
It is also possible to initialize (format) a DVD-RAM disk with  
this menu.  
HDD  
REC Rate  
I
Normal Recording Area  
Event Recording Area  
Copy Area  
COPY1  
COPY2  
CONTINUE  
CONTINUE  
STOP  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
STOP  
I
I
STOP  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Auto Delete  
REC Rate  
I
I
OFF  
Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Delete before 01 JAN 03  
DELETE  
Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
Delete before 01  
Disc Format of DVD  
Disk Info  
.
.
Access Log  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
I
I
.
JAN  
DELETE  
.
03  
COPY1  
FORMAT  
FORMAT  
COPY2  
Event Log  
Error Log  
CONTINUE: When the available disk space has run out, the  
older data will be overwritten by the newer data. In this  
case, the oldest data is the first to be overwritten.  
STOP: When the available disk space has run out, record-  
ing and copying will be canceled.  
Access Log  
8Auto Delete  
It is possible to delete recorded images automatically when  
the set number of days has passed from the day the image  
was recorded. Refer to a system administrator for further  
information.  
The number of days for the auto delete function is as fol-  
lows.  
Important:  
When changing the setting from CONTINUE to STOP  
during overwriting, the oldest 1 hours worth of record-  
ed images will be deleted. It is impossible to recover  
the deleted images even if it is set to CONTINUE again.  
The auto delete function will not work when OFF is selected.  
OFF/1DAY/2DAYS/3DAYS/4DAYS/5DAYS/6DAYS/7DAYS/  
8DAYS/9DAYS/10DAYS/14DAYS/30DAYS/45DAYS/  
60DAYS/90DAYS/120DAYS/150DAYS/180DAYS  
Note: When copying on a CD-R or DVD-R disk, copying will  
stop automatically when the available disk space has  
run out even though CONTINUE is selected.  
Note: Images recorded on the HDD copy area will not be  
[Disk Capacity] Set actions to be taken when  
deleted.  
the available disk space is running out  
8Manual Delete for Normal Recording Area  
Select an action from the following to be taken when the  
available space of the built-in hard disk (normal recording  
area, event recording area, copy area) or the external  
recording device (DVD-RAM, CD-R or DVD-R disk drive)  
connected to the copy port (COPY1, COPY2) reaches a  
specified level.  
By setting the time and date, images in the normal record-  
ing area of the hard disk that were recorded up until a day  
before the set time and date will be deleted.  
Enter a 2-digit number for the year when entering the time  
and date.  
The setting range is between 1 % and 10 % (in 1 % inter-  
vals).  
The warning will not be issued when OFF is selected.  
8Manual Delete for Event Recording Area  
By setting the time and date, images in the event recording  
area of the hard disk that were recorded up until a day  
before the set time and date will be deleted.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
HDD Capacity Warning  
REC Rate  
I
Normal Recording Area  
Event Recording Area  
Copy Area  
COPY1 Capacity Warning  
COPY2 Capacity Warning  
OFF  
10  
10  
10  
10  
Disk Info  
8Disc Format of DVD  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
I
I
Initialize (format) a DVD-RAM disk in the DVD-RAM drive  
connected to the copy port.  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
95  
[Event Log] Check the event log  
[Error Log] Check the error log  
The event log (time and date at an event occurrence,  
details) will be displayed in list form.  
The error log will be displayed in list form.  
Refer to page 45 for further information about each event.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
No.  
Time&Date  
Event  
REC Rate  
001 25.MAR.03 11:50:11 PM H.METER MAIN1-1  
002 25.MAR.03 11:49:22 PM AL 1-0312312359  
003 25.MAR.03 11:39:21 PM R-ERR EXT1-2  
004 25.MAR.03 11:33:22 PM CAM LOSS1  
005 25.MAR.03 11:30:26 PM PWR RECOVER  
006 25.MAR.03 11:24:11 PM H.METER MAIN1-1  
007 25.MAR.03 11:20:11 PM AL1-0312312359  
008 25.MAR.03 11:11:11 PM R-ERR EXT1-2  
009 25.MAR.03 11:10:31 PM CAM LOSS1  
010 25.MAR.03 11:09:28 PM PWR RECOVER  
011 25.MAR.03 11:04:52 PM H.METER MAIN1-1  
012 25.MAR.03 10:59:12 PM AL1-0312312359  
013 25.MAR.03 10:51:00 PM R-ERR EXT1-2  
014 25.MAR.03 10:43:54 PM COM LOSS1  
015 25.MAR.03 10:37:59 PM PWR RECOVER  
016 25.MAR.03 10:35:13 PM H.METER MAIN1-1  
017 25.MAR.03 10:24:03 PM AL1-0312312359  
018 25.MAR.03 10:06:42 PM R-ERR EXT1-2  
019 25.MAR.03 09:58:29 PM COM LOSS1  
020 25.MAR.03 09:24:14 PM PWR RECOVER  
Disk Info  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
LIVE  
No.  
Time&Date  
Event  
REC Rate Status  
Disk Info  
001 25.MAR.03 11:50:11 PM  
002 25.MAR.03 11:49:22 PM  
003 25.MAR.03 11:39:21 PM  
004 25.MAR.03 11:33:22 PM  
005 25.MAR.03 11:30:26 PM  
006 25.MAR.03 11:24:11 PM  
007 25.MAR.03 11:20:11 PM  
008 25.MAR.03 11:11:11 PM  
009 25.MAR.03 11:10:31 PM  
010 25.MAR.03 11:09:28 PM  
011 25.MAR.03 11:04:52 PM  
012 25.MAR.03 10:59:12 PM  
013 25.MAR.03 10:51:00 PM  
014 25.MAR.03 10:43:54 PM  
015 25.MAR.03 10:37:59 PM  
016 25.MAR.03 10:35:13 PM  
017 25.MAR.03 10:24:03 PM  
018 25.MAR.03 10:06:42 PM  
019 25.MAR.03 09:58:29 PM  
020 25.MAR.03 09:24:14 PM  
LOSS16  
TRM-1  
VMD-14  
EMR  
COM-13  
LOSS-15  
TRM-12  
VMD-4  
EMR  
COM-8  
LOSS-16  
TRM-1  
VMD-14  
EMR  
COM-13  
LOSS-15  
TRM-12  
VMD-4  
EMR  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
PREV/NEXT PAGE  
Event Log  
Error Log  
Access Log  
COM-8  
PREV/NEXT PAGE  
Note: Up to 100 error logs can be kept. When more than  
100 error logs are filed, the older error logs will be over-  
written by the newer error logs. In this case, the oldest  
log is the first to be overwritten.  
COM: Command alarm  
EMR: Emergency recording  
LOSS: Video loss  
TRM: Terminal alarm  
VMD: Motion detection  
Note: Up to 750 event logs can be kept. When more than  
750 event logs are filed, the older event logs will be  
overwritten by the newer event logs. In this case, the  
oldest log is the first to be overwritten.  
Indication  
Description  
Cause  
AL*-YYMMDDhhmmss  
Asterisk (*) indicates the camera channel Detects alteration  
number  
YYDDMMhhmmss indicates the played  
time when the alteration was detected.  
W-ERR X-Y  
X indicates the unit/unit number that has  
the hard disk error  
Y indicates the disk number in the unit  
(unit number)  
Failed to write data on the HDD  
Auto removal of the link  
REMOVE X-Y  
X indicates the unit/unit number that has  
the hard disk that has been removed  
from the subject for recording.  
Y indicates the disk number in the  
unit/unit number  
#-FULL  
# indicates the partition name/external  
recording device port number  
No available disk space  
THERMAL -X  
FAN X-Y  
X indicates the unit/unit number in which Thermal error  
the thermal error occurred  
X indicates the unit/unit number  
Y indicates the fan number (1-4)  
Y will be left out if the malfunctioning fan  
is in the extension unit  
The fan is malfunctioning  
#-nn%  
# indicates the partition name of the hard Warning that the disk space is running  
disk/external recording device  
out  
nn indicates the available disk space  
96  
Indication  
Description  
Cause  
HDD SMART error  
SMART X-Y  
PWR LOSS  
H.METER X-Y  
X indicates the unit/unit number that has  
the hard disk error  
Y indicates the unit/unit number  
Detects a power outage  
Hour-meter warning  
X indicates the unit/unit number that has  
the hard disk error  
Y indicates the unit/unit number  
PROTECT -#  
NO DISK -#  
MEDIUM -#  
# indicates the port number to which the  
external recording device is connected  
Disk has a write protection  
Disk is not inserted  
Incompatible disk  
# indicates the port number to which the  
external recording device is connected  
# indicates the port number to which the  
external recording device is connected  
UNFORMATTED -#  
W-ERR (MEDIUM-#)  
PWR RECOVER  
# indicates the port number to which the  
external recording device is connected  
Unformatted disk  
# indicates the port number to which the  
external recording device is connected  
Failed to write data on the disk (CD-R,  
DVD-RAM and DVD-R)  
Recover from a power outage  
Notes:  
[Access Log] Check the access log  
Up to 100 access logs can be kept. When more than  
100 access logs are filed, the older access logs will be  
overwritten by the newer access logs. In this case, the  
oldest log is the first to be overwritten.  
The time, user name and IP addresses when logging in/out  
to/from this unit will be displayed in list form.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Logs of accesses via an FTP will not be displayed.  
REC Rate  
No.  
Time&Date  
Event  
001 25.MAR.03 11:50:11 PM 192.168.100.100 IN  
002 25.MAR.03 11:49:22 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT  
003 25.MAR.03 11:39:21 PM tshimi IN  
Disk Info  
Version Info  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
004 25.MAR.03 11:33:22 PM tshimi OUT  
005 25.MAR.03 11:30:26 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT  
006 25.MAR.03 11:24:00 PM 192.168.100.100 IN  
007 25.MAR.03 11:20:11 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT  
008 25.MAR.03 11:11:23 PM tshimi IN  
009 25.MAR.03 11:10:31 PM tshimi OUT  
010 25.MAR.03 11:09:28 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT  
011 25.MAR.03 11:04:52 PM 192.168 100.100 IN  
012 25.MAR.03 10:59:12 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT  
013 25.MAR.03 10:51:11 PM tshimi IN  
014 25.MAR.03 10:43:54 PM tshimi OUT  
015 25.MAR.03 10:37:59 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT  
016 25.MAR.03 10:35:13 PM 192.168.100.100 IN  
017 25.MAR.03 10:24:03 PM 1234567890123456789012345678901 OUT  
018 25.MAR.03 10:06:42 PM tshimi IN  
Event Log  
Error Log  
019 25.MAR.03 09:58:29 PM tshimi OUT  
020 25.MAR.03 09:24:14 PM 123.123.123.123 OUT  
Access Log  
PREV/NEXT PAGE  
**IN: The user name or the IP address displayed before IN  
indicates the user/host logged in.  
**OUT: The user name or the IP address displayed before  
OUT indicates the user/host logged out.  
**: A user name or host name will be displayed.  
97  
I [Recording]  
Perform the settings for the basic recording (REC Setup)  
and the emergency recording.  
Important:  
When operating on monitor 1 when "MON2" is selected  
for "Manual Recording Channel" on the "REC Setup"  
menu, all camera channels will be recorded by manual  
recording instead of recording the camera channel dis-  
played on monitor 2.  
When "MON2" is selected, images from a camera chan-  
nel for another manual recording that has started later  
will be recorded regardless of the operation using the  
buttons on the front panel or via a network.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
ON  
OFF  
All  
REC Setup  
Recording  
Power ON Manual REC  
Manual Recording Channel  
Embedded REC(Title)  
Embedded REC(Time&Date)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
Emergency REC  
ON  
ON  
REC Priority  
PRIORITY  
REC MODE  
Manual REC  
Event REC  
1
2
3
Schedule REC  
Audio Allocation  
AUDIO  
I
CAMERA  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
Audio1  
Audio2  
Audio3  
Audio4  
8Embedded REC (Title)  
Select ON or OFF to determine whether or not to record a  
displayed camera title together as a part of the recorded  
image.  
[REC Setup] Perform the settings for the  
basic recording.  
ON: Record camera titles together as a part of the record-  
ed image.  
Perform the following settings for the basic recording.  
OFF: Does not record camera titles.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
ON  
OFF  
All  
REC Setup  
Recording  
Power ON Manual REC  
Manual Recording Channel  
Embedded REC(Title)  
Embedded REC(Time&Date)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
8Embedded REC (Time & Date)  
Emergency REC  
ON  
ON  
Select ON or OFF to determine whether or not to record the  
displayed time and date together.  
ON: Record the time and date together as a part of the  
recorded image.  
REC Priority  
PRIORITY  
REC MODE  
Manual REC  
Event REC  
1
2
3
Schedule REC  
Audio Allocation  
AUDIO  
I
CAMERA  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
Audio1  
Audio2  
Audio3  
Audio4  
OFF: Does not record the time and date.  
8Recording  
Important:  
It is possible to select ON or OFF to determine whether  
or not to display the camera title during playback even  
though OFF is selected. (Refer to pages 114, 115.)  
When ON is selected, it is impossible to hide the cam-  
era title and the time and date. (Refer to pages 114,  
115.)  
Select ON or OFF to record or not record.  
ON: Recording will be performed.  
OFF: No recording will be performed.  
Important:  
When OFF is selected for this setting, no recording will  
be performed. Select ON for normal use except when it  
is necessary to stop recording forcibly such as when a  
problem has occurred with the unit.  
8REC Priority  
Assigns priorities to recording modes. Assigns priorities 1  
(highest) - 3 (lowest) to each recording mode. When two or  
more recordings are performed in the same period, only a  
recording with the highest priority will be performed.  
Refer to page 19 for further information about each record-  
ing mode.  
8Power ON Manual REC  
Select ON or OFF to determine whether or not to start  
recording when the power is turned on by the connected  
external timer (or the switch).  
ON: Manual recording will start automatically after complet-  
ing the system check.  
OFF: Manual recording will not start automatically after  
completing the system check.  
Important:  
The priority of event recording will be applied for the  
priority of pre-/post-event recording. When pre-/post-  
event recording is to be performed, it is impossible to  
perform manual recording/schedule recording.  
Important:  
When ON is selected, manual recording will start auto-  
matically after completing the system check.  
8Audio Allocation  
Allocates audio from the audio input connectors (1 - 4) on  
the rear panel of the unit to camera channels.  
Allocate audio in accordance with the channels of the con-  
nected cameras. When OFF is selected, audio will not be  
heard.  
8Manual Recording Channel  
Select a camera channel for manual recording from the fol-  
lowing. Refer to page 19 for manual recording.  
MON2: Images from the camera channel currently dis-  
played on monitor 2 will be recorded.  
ALL: Images from all the camera channels will be record-  
ed.  
98  
Important:  
MANUAL: Recording will continue while the external switch  
is being held down.  
CONTINUE: Recording will not stop until the ALARM  
RESET button on the front panel of the unit is pressed.  
When a live image from the audio assigned camera  
channel is displayed on a single screen on monitor 2,  
audio will be heard. When displaying on a multi-screen,  
audio will not be heard.  
When images from the audio assigned camera channel  
are displayed on a single screen, recorded audio will  
be heard. When displaying on a multi-screen, recorded  
audio will not be heard.  
Audio will be recorded regardless of whether you are  
displaying on a single screen or a multi-screen.  
Audio may be recorded fragmentary occasionally.  
8Recording Rate and Quality  
Perform the settings for the recording rate and image quali-  
ty for emergency recording.  
The following are available for the recording rate.  
OFF/1 ips/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/  
12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips  
Important:  
When OFF is selected for a specified camera channel,  
images from a camera channel set to OFF will not be  
recorded.  
[Emergency REC] Perform the settings for  
emergency recording  
When "FRAME 3D ON" or "FRAME 3D OFF" is selected,  
the total recording rates of CAM 1 - CAM 16 (for the  
WJ-HD316) must be less than 25 ips.  
When "FIELD" is selected, the total recording rates of  
CAM 1 - CAM 16 (for the WJ-HD316) must be less than  
50 ips.  
Perform the settings for emergency recording such as the  
recording time or recording rate for emergency recording.  
Refer to page 21 for further information about emergency  
recording.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
When "SIF" is selected, the total recording rates of CAM  
1 - CAM 16 (for the WJ-HD316) must be less than  
100 ips.  
When "FRAME 3D ON", "FRAME 3D OFF" or "SIF" is  
selected, it is impossible to select 50 ips.  
REC Setup  
Resolution  
Recording Time  
Recording Rate and Quality  
FIELD  
10s  
I
I
I
Emergency REC  
RATE  
Quality  
RATE  
Quality  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
2.5ips  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
SFA CAM9  
SFA CAM10  
SFA  
SFA CAM12  
SFA CAM13  
SFA CAM14  
SFA CAM15  
SFA CAM16  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
CAM11  
Auto Copy  
OFF  
I
The following are available for the image quality.  
SFA/SFB: Top quality (SUPER FINE)  
FQA/FQB: High quality (FINE)  
NQA/NQB: Standard quality (NORMAL)  
EXA/EXB: Low quality (EXTENDED)  
8Resolution  
Select a recording resolution from the following.  
FRAME 3D ON: High resolution (720 x 576), with camera  
shake compensation  
FRAME 3D OFF: High resolution (720 x 576)  
FIELD: Standard resolution (720 x 288)  
SIF: Low resolution (360 x 288)  
**A is suitable for less dynamic images.  
**B is suitable for more dynamic images.  
Important:  
When "B/W" is selected for the colour mode, do not  
select "SFA", "FQA", "NQA" or "EXA" for the image quali-  
ty. Otherwise, the image quality may become poor.  
(The colour mode setting is available only using a PC  
via a network.)  
Important:  
It is recommended to set the same value for the resolu-  
tion of emergency recording as the resolution of manual  
recording, event recording and schedule recording.  
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds  
from the beginning of emergency recording when the  
resolution is switched.  
8Auto Copy  
Select ON or OFF to set whether or not to automatically  
copy images recorded by emergency recording onto the  
copy area on the built-in hard disk or DVD-RAM disk.  
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds  
just after emergency recording has finished.  
Important:  
8Recording Time  
When OFF is selected for "Auto Copy" on "Basic setup"  
of "System", the auto copy function will not work after  
emergency recording even though ON is selected for  
this setting. Select "HDD", "COPY 1" or "COPY 2" for  
"Auto Copy".  
Perform the settings for the recording time and recording  
action for emergency recording.  
The following are available for the recording time.  
1 s - 10 s (in 1 second intervals)  
20 s/30 s  
1 m - 10 m (in 1 minute intervals)  
20 m/30 m/40 m/50 m/60 m  
99  
I [Event] Function for Events  
Perform the settings for event actions of each event type  
(motion detection, video loss, command alarm and terminal  
alarm).  
The following are available for the buzzer sound duration.  
When OFF is selected, a buzzer will not sound.  
(s: second, m: minute)  
OFF: The buzzer will not sound.  
1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
/40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m  
EXT: The buzzer will continue until the ALARM RESET but-  
ton is pressed.  
Event Setup  
VMD Setup  
VMD  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
I
I
I
Video Loss  
Terminal/Command Alarm  
Alarm Setup  
Terminal Setup  
[VMD Setup] Perform the settings for the  
motion detection function  
Select ON or OFF to determine whether to enable or dis-  
able the motion detection function for each camera chan-  
nel.  
When ON is selected, perform the settings for the motion  
detection area for each camera channel. Up to 4 areas can  
be set for a camera channel for the detection area. Refer to  
page 45 for further information about the motion detection  
function.  
[Event Setup] Settings for the alarm output  
duration and the buzzer duration  
Perform the settings for the alarm output duration and the  
buzzer sound duration for each event type (motion detec-  
tion, video loss, command alarm and terminal alarm).  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Event Setup  
VMD Setup  
VMD  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
I
I
I
Video Loss  
Terminal/Command Alarm  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
CAM9  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
ON  
Event Setup  
VMD Setup  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Alarm Setup  
Terminal Setup  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
Alarm Setup  
Terminal Setup  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Event Setup  
VMD Setup  
VMD  
SETUP  
SETUP  
P  
I
I
Video Loss Setup  
Alarm Setup  
Terminal Setup  
Alarm Output  
Buzzer  
I
I
1 0 s  
1 0 s  
O K  
CANCEL  
The following are available for the alarm output duration.  
When OFF is selected, the alarm output will not be sup-  
plied.  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the camera channel selection menu of  
the "VMD Setup" window.  
(s: second, m: minute)  
OFF: No alarm output is supplied.  
1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)  
/40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m  
EXT: Alarm output will continue until the ALARM RESET  
button is pressed.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
CAM9  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
ON  
Event Setup  
VMD Setup  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
Alarm Setup  
Terminal Setup  
Important:  
The alarm output duration cannot be set for video loss.  
Signals will be supplied continuously from the camera  
error output terminal (pin no. 17) of the ALARM/CON-  
TROL connector on the rear panel during the period  
when the video signal is lost. (Refer to page 83.)  
z Rotate the jog dial to select ON for a desired camera  
channel for which the motion detection function is to be  
applied, and press the SET button.  
100  
[Screenshot 2]  
[Screenshot 5]  
The "VMD Setup" window will be displayed.  
The motion detection area is set with the start point and the  
end point as the points at opposite angles of the motion  
detection area.  
x Rotate the jog dial to select "SETUP AREA" on the status  
bar.  
Note: To set all areas on the monitor as the motion  
detection area, select "ALL AREAS" and press the  
SET button.  
b Repeat steps 3 and 4 to set another motion detection  
area.  
Up to 4 areas can be set. The newly created areas will  
be named automatically as A, B, C and D in the order of  
creation.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The cross cursor will be displayed on the "VMD Setup" win-  
dow.  
n To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select  
"EXIT" on the status bar, and press the SET button.  
The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.  
Delete the motion detection area  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the "VMD Setup" window.  
c Move the cross cursor to a desired point to be set as  
the start point of the motion detection area using the  
arrows button, and press the SET button.  
[Screenshot 4]  
The start point of the motion detection area is assigned.  
z Rotate the jog dial to select "DELETE AREA" on the sta-  
tus bar.  
Note: After selecting "DELETE ALL AREAS", pressing  
the SET button will delete all of the motion detection  
areas.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The cross cursor will be displayed on the "VMD Setup" win-  
dow.  
v Move the cross cursor to a desired point to be set as  
the end point of the motion detection area using the  
arrows button, and press the SET button.  
101  
x Move the cross cursor onto an area to be deleted using  
8Set the detection mode  
the arrows button and press the SET button.  
Perform the settings of the detection mode (method of  
detection) in the set detection area. Specifying a method of  
detection in a detection area is available by setting the  
detection mode.  
c To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select  
"EXIT" on the status bar.  
The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the "VMD Setup" window.  
8Set the sensitivity  
Set the sensitivity for the created motion detection area.  
Sensitivity can be set for each area.  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the "VMD Setup" window.  
z Rotate the jog dial to select "VMD MODE" on the status  
bar.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The detection mode menu will be displayed.  
z Rotate the jog dial to select "SENSITIVITY" on the status  
bar.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The sensitivity of the selected detection area will be dis-  
played.  
x Set the detection mode.  
Move the cursor to the desired detection mode using  
the arrows button (AB).  
Move the cursor on the desired detection mode using  
the arrows button (A B) and check the radio button  
next to the selected mode using the arrows button (C  
D).  
x Move the cross cursor to select an area using the  
Refer to the following for further information about each  
of the detection modes.  
arrows button (A B).  
c Select the sensitivity for the selected area from the fol-  
lowing.  
<ANY AREA>  
An event action will be performed according to the set-  
tings when "motion" is detected in any of the set motion  
detection areas.  
OFF: No motion will be detected in this area.  
LOW: Low sensitivity  
MID: Standard sensitivity  
HIGH: High sensitivity  
<VECTOR>  
Move the cursor to an area for the settings of VECTOR  
using the arrows button (B) and select an area using  
the arrows button (C D). Move the cursor to the para-  
meter box of the selected area using the arrows button  
(B), and then press the arrows button (C D) to select  
an interval time for an object moving between each  
area from the following.  
v To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select  
"EXIT" on the status bar, and press the SET button.  
The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.  
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m(min)  
102  
<DURATION>  
Move the cursor to the parameter box of each area  
Motion is detected in area C within 20 seconds after  
being detected in area B.  
using the arrows button (B) and select a moving dura-  
tion for an object in each area from the following using  
the arrows button (CD).  
Motion is detected in area D within 10 seconds after  
being detected in area C.  
When all of the above have occurred, an event action  
will be performed.  
--/5 s/10 s/20 s/30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m  
c To complete the settings, rotate the jog dial to select  
"EXIT" on the status bar, and press the SET button.  
The "VMD Setup" window will be closed.  
<DURATION (to detect objects that keep moving in the  
area)>  
An event action will be performed according to the set-  
tings when an object keeps moving for the set period in  
the detection area. For example, in case of the following  
settings; 10 sec. for the areas A and B, 20 sec. for area  
C and 30 sec. for area D:  
8About the Detection mode  
Perform the settings of the detection mode (method of  
detection) in the set detection area. Specifying a method of  
detection in a detection area is available by setting the  
detection mode.  
An event action will be performed when an object  
keeps moving for 10 seconds in area A or B, or for 20  
seconds in area C, or for 30 seconds in area D.  
There are three detection modes as follows.  
Important:  
Activating two or more detection modes simultaneously  
is not possible.  
A
C
B
D
<ANY AREA (to detect "motion" in the area)>  
An event action will be performed according to the set-  
tings when "motion" is detected in any of the set motion  
detection areas.  
[Alarm Setup] Perform the settings for the  
A
C
B
D
alarm auto reset and alarm disarm  
Perform the settings for the alarm display duration. The  
alarm display will automatically disappear when the display  
duration has passed. (Alarm Auto Reset)  
Perform the settings to suspend the set duration when the  
same type of event (motion detection, video loss, terminal  
alarm, command alarm) has occurred sequentially so that  
the event action will not be performed each time. (Alarm  
Disarm)  
Any motion will be detected anywhere in the A, B, C, D  
areas.  
<VECTOR (to detect object moving to a certain direc-  
tion)>  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Event Setup  
VMD Setup  
Alarm Auto Reset  
Alarm Disarm Time  
OFF  
2s  
I
I
An event action will be performed according to the set-  
tings when an object moves within the set time to the  
other detection area in the set order.  
Alarm Setup  
Terminal Setup  
10 s  
A
C
B
D
8Alarm Auto Reset  
The following are possible for the alarm auto reset.  
When OFF is selected, the alarm display will not automati-  
cally disappear.  
10 s  
To erase the alarm display, press the ALARM RESET but-  
ton.  
OFF/1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)  
40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m4 m/5 m  
The following is an example.  
Motion is detected in area B within 10 seconds after  
being detected in area A.  
103  
8Alarm Disarm Time  
The following are possible for the alarm disarm.  
2 s - 10 s (in 1 second intervals)  
[Terminal Setup] Perform the settings for  
the alarm terminal polarity.  
Select how to supply the signal to the alarm terminal.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Event Setup  
VMD Setup  
Terminal Setup  
N.O.  
I
Alarm Setup  
Terminal Setup  
N.O.: Signals will be supplied when short-circuited.  
(Normally Open)  
N.C.: Signals will be supplied when open-circuited.  
(Normally Closed)  
Note: It is possible to set polarities for each of the alarm  
inputs 1-16 respectively using a PC via a network.  
104  
I [Schedule] Settings for the recording/event action schedule  
Perform the settings for the recording schedules of record-  
ing and event action by designating a day of the week and  
time.  
8Resolution  
Select a resolution for images to be recorded from the fol-  
lowing.  
A day can be divided into up to 6 time zones, and record-  
ing programs and event action programs can be assigned  
to each time zone to create a recording schedule.  
Up to 4 normal recording programs (REC Program) and up  
to 4 event action programs (Event Program) can be creat-  
ed. Perform the settings for the REC Program: resolution  
and recording rate. Perform the settings for the Event  
Program: action mode for each event type and auto copy.  
It is possible to create special days apart from the normal  
schedule, and a recording program of another day of the  
week can be switched to a special days program automati-  
cally.  
FRAME 3D ON: High resolution (720 x 576) with the motion  
blur compensation  
FRAME 3D OFF: High resolution (720 x 576)  
FIELD: Standard resolution (720 x 288)  
SIF: Low resolution (360 x 288)  
Note: When "FRAME 3D ON" is selected, it is possible to  
record a moving object with less blurring.  
Important:  
It is recommended to set same value for the resolution  
of emergency recording as the resolution of manual  
recording and schedule recording.  
Flowchart on how to create a schedule  
Follow the procedures below to create schedules.  
In the following cases, recording will not be performed  
for around 4 seconds:  
When resolution is switched such as when a different  
resolution is set depending on different time zones  
When the SETUP MENU is closed after changing the  
settings  
Create REC Program/Event Program.  
(aPage 105 and 107)  
8Recording Rate for Each Recording Mode  
Create a timetable. (aPage 108)  
Perform the settings of the recording rate for each record-  
ing mode (manual recording, schedule recording and event  
recording).  
Assign REC Program/Event Program to a timetable.  
Assign the maximum recording rates according to the reso-  
lution for each recording mode.  
(aPage 108)  
The following are the maximum recording rate for each res-  
olution.  
[REC Program] Create a recording program  
Perform the settings of resolution, and recording rate for  
each recording mode, and the recording rate and image  
quality of each camera channel. Up to 4 recording pro-  
grams can be created.  
Resolution  
FRAME 3D ON  
FRAME 3D OFF  
FIELD  
Maximum recording rate  
25 ips  
25 ips  
50 ips  
100 ips  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
SIF  
LIVE  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
Event Program 1  
Event Program 2  
Event Program 3  
Event Program 4  
Time Table  
I
I
I
I
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
The following are available for the recording rate for each  
resolution.  
OFF/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/12.5 ips/  
25 ips/50 ips/100 ips  
Important:  
When "FRAME" is selected for "Resolution", "50 ips" and  
"100 ips" are not available. When "FIELD" is selected,  
"100 ips" is not available.  
The total of the recording rates for each recording  
mode must be less than the maximum recording rate of  
each resolution.  
Examples: When "FIELD" is selected and set, the total  
of the recording rates for each recording mode  
must be less than 50 ips.  
Recording Program 1  
SET
Resolution  
FIELD
I
I
Recording Table  
Manual REC 15 ipsSchedule REC 15 ipsEvent REC 30 ips  
M  
Tim
REC
MANUAL  
SCHEDULE  
PRE EVENT  
POST EVENT  
TIME RATE QUALITY  
RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY  
TIME  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SFA  
SFA  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
Eve
SFA  
Spe
CAM4  
SFA  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
CAM9  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
CANCEL  
O K
Manual recording: 12.5 ips  
Schedule recording: 12.5 ips  
Event recording: 25 ips  
105  
The total of the recording rates between recording rates of  
pre-event recording and recording rates of post-event  
recording for each camera channel must be less than the  
recording rate as described in "Recording Rate for Each  
Recording Mode" above.  
8Recording Rate and Image Quality for Each  
Camera Channel  
Perform the settings for recording rate, image quality and  
recording duration for each camera channel (only for pre-  
event recording and post-event recording).  
Perform the settings for each recording mode. Assign the  
recording rate for each camera channel as described in  
"Recording Rate for Each Recording Mode" above.  
The following are for the recording rate. When OFF is  
selected, images from the selected camera channel will not  
be recorded.  
OFF/0.1 ips/0.2 ips/0.3 ips/0.4 ips/0.5 ips/1 ips/1.7 ips/  
2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips  
AUTO: The recording rate will be set automatically. (Not  
possible for pre-event recording and post-event record-  
ing)  
The following are available for the image quality.  
SFA/SFB: Top quality (SUPER FINE)  
FQA/FQB: High quality (FINE)  
NQA/NQB: Standard quality (NORMAL)  
EXA/EXB: Low quality (EXTENDED)  
**A is suitable for less dynamic images.  
**B is suitable for more dynamic images.  
The following are available for the recording duration (only  
event pre-recording and event post-recording).  
1 s - 10 s (in 1 second intervals)  
20 s/30 s/1 - 10 m (in 1 minute intervals)  
20 - 60 m (in 10 minutes intervals)  
Note: When "AUTO" is selected for a camera channel, the  
maximum recording rate of this camera channel will be  
one of the following parameters but less than the value  
resulting from the following formula.  
MAN. (MANUAL): The recording duration will be as follows  
depending on the event type.  
At a motion detection: For 8 seconds  
At a video loss occurrence: During a video loss occur-  
rence  
Parameters:  
0.1 ips/0.2 ips/0.3 ips/0.4 ips/0.5 ips/1 ips/2 ips/3 ips/  
5 ips/6 ips/7.5 ips/10 ips/15 ips/30 ips/60 ips  
Formula:  
At a terminal alarm occurrence: During the supply of a  
signal  
(Recording rate of each recording mode) (Recording rate of  
camera channels whose recording rate is numerically set (ips))  
At a command alarm: For 8 seconds  
CON. (CONTINUE): Recording will be performed continu-  
ously until the ALARM RESET button is pressed.  
Number of camera channels whose recording rate is AUTO  
However, when "FRAME 3D ON", "FRAME 3D OFF" or  
"SIF" is selected, the maximum recording rate of this  
camera channel will be up to 25 ips.  
Notes:  
Available recording duration for pre-event recording will  
differ depending on the settings of "Resolution" and  
"Recording Rate and Quality" for pre-event recording as  
below:  
Important:  
The total of the recording rates of camera channels in  
the same recording mode must be less than the record-  
ing rate as described in "Recording Rate for Each  
Recording Mode" above.  
Examples: When selecting "FIELD" for resolution,  
"12.5 ips" for manual recording, "12.5 ips" for sched-  
ule recording, "25 ips" for event recording:  
Total recording rates of CAM 1 - 16 (manual record-  
ing): less than 12.5 ips  
Recording  
rate  
FRAME 3D ON FIELD  
FRAME 3D OFF  
SIF  
0.1  
0.2  
0.3  
0.4  
0.5  
1
5 m (min)  
2 m (min)  
1 m (min)  
1 m (min)  
1 m (min)  
30 s  
10 m (min)  
20 m (min)  
10 m (min)  
6 m (min)  
5 m (min)  
4 m (min)  
2 m (min)  
1 m (min)  
30 s  
5 m (min)  
3 m (min)  
2 m (min)  
2 m (min)  
1 m (min)  
30 s  
Total recording rates of CAM 1 - 16 (schedule  
recording): less than 12.5 ips  
Total recording rates of CAM 1 - 16 (event record-  
ing): less than 25 ips  
1.7  
2.5  
4.2  
5
10 s  
10 s  
20 s  
7 s  
10 s  
20 s  
When the total of the recording rates becomes more than  
the set value, the recording mode section will turn red.  
6 s  
10 s  
20 s  
6.3  
8.3  
12.5  
25  
4 s  
9 s  
10 s  
3 s  
7 s  
10 s  
Recording Program 1  
FIELD
SET
Resolution  
Recording Table  
I
I
2 s  
4 s  
9 s  
Manual REC 15 ipsSchedule REC 15 ipsEvent REC 30 ips  
M  
Tim
REC
MANUAL  
SCHEDULE  
PRE EVENT  
POST EVENT  
RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY RATE QUALITY  
TIME RATE QUALITY  
TIME  
1 s  
2 s  
4 s  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
AUTO  
SFA  
SFA  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
1ips  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
5s  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
30s  
Eve
SFA  
Spe
CAM4  
SFA  
50  
-
1 s  
-
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
CAM9  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
SFA  
CANCEL  
4  
O K
106  
When a pre-recording area is created in an optional  
extension unit (WJ-HDE300 series), it is possible to per-  
form pre-event recording for up to 60 minutes accord-  
ing to the resolution, recording rate and disk space for  
pre-event recording. Refer to page 135 for descriptions  
of how to create the pre-recording area. Pre-event  
recording for the camera channel that has the pre-  
recording area in the extension unit will always be per-  
formed on the pre-recording area.  
8VMD  
Perform the settings of event action at a motion detection or  
the settings of the auto copy function.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
Event Program 1  
Event Program 2  
Event Program 3  
Time Table  
I
I
I
I
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
VMD  
Operation Mode  
Auto Copy  
I
I
ALARM  
OFF  
OK  
CANCEL  
When the set pre-event recording duration is impossi-  
ble to apply, recording mode section of pre-event  
recording will turn red.  
When the recording rate is low, images may be record-  
ed for a longer duration than the set pre-event record-  
ing duration.  
Pre-event recording will not be performed for a camera  
channel whose post-event recording rate is OFF.  
Perform the settings for the following operation mode. Refer  
to page 45 for further information about each operation  
mode.  
ACT DET (Activity Detection Mode): Performs only  
recording, writing an event log and camera movement  
to a preset position at an event occurrence. Other event  
actions will not be performed.  
ALARM (Alarm Mode): Performs every event action  
according to the settings.  
Important:  
Pre-event recording image only just recorded will be delet-  
ed in the following cases:  
When the SETUP MENU is closed after changing the  
settings  
When post-event recording is newly performed  
When the time zone of a schedule switched and record-  
ing had just started  
Auto copy is the function to copy recorded images auto-  
matically onto the copy area of the hard disk or the DVD-  
RAM disk.  
When the date has been changed  
Select ON or OFF to enable or disable the auto copy func-  
tion.  
ON: Enable the auto copy function  
OFF: Disable the auto copy function  
[Event Program] Create event programs for  
an event occurrence  
Perform the settings of event action for each event type  
(motion detection, video loss, terminal/command alarm) or  
of auto copy.  
Important:  
When "OFF" is selected for "Auto Copy" of "Basic Setup"  
on "System", the auto copy function will not work even  
though "ON" is selected for this setting.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Select "HDD", "COPY 1" or "COPY 2" for "Auto Copy".  
Images recorded (by pre-event recording) in the pre-  
recording area in the extension unit will not be copied  
automatically.  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
Event Program 1  
Event Program 2  
Event Program 3  
Event Program 4  
Time Table  
I
I
I
I
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
8Video Loss  
Perform the settings of an event action at a video loss or the  
settings of the auto copy function.  
The contents to be set are the same as the settings for  
"VMD" above.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
Event Program 1  
Event Program 2  
Event Program 3  
I
I
I
Time Table  
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
Event Program 1  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
SETUP  
VMD  
Video Loss  
Terminal/Command Alarm  
I
I
I
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
Event Program 1  
Event Program 2  
Event Program 3  
Time Table  
I
I
I
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
O K  
CANCEL  
Video Loss  
Operation Mode  
Auto Copy  
I
I
ALARM  
OFF  
OK  
CANCEL  
107  
[Screenshot 2]  
8Terminal/command alarm  
The pop-up setting menu of the timetable for every day of  
the week will be displayed.  
The cursor will be displayed and will move to "MON"  
(Monday).  
Perform the settings of an event action at a terminal/com-  
mand alarm occurrence or the settings of the auto copy  
function.  
The contents to be set are the same as the settings for  
"VMD" above.  
Maintenance  
Recording  
Event  
12PM  
SETUP MENU  
12AM  
12AM  
6AM  
6PM  
REC  
EVT  
MON  
Time Table  
REC  
EVT  
TUE  
WED  
THU  
FRI  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
REC Progra
Event Progr
Special Da
REC  
EVT  
LIVE  
REC  
EVT  
SETUP  
SETUP  
SETUP  
Event Program 1  
Event Program 2  
Event Program 3  
I
I
I
Time Table  
REC  
EVT  
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
REC  
EVT  
SAT  
SUN  
DAILY  
EXT  
Terminal/CommandAlarm  
REC  
EVT  
Operation Mode  
Auto Copy  
I
I
ALARM  
OFF  
REC  
EVT  
REC  
EVT  
OK  
CANCEL  
OK  
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT  
CANCEL  
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4  
x Select a day of the week using the arrows button (CD)  
and press the SET button.  
Note: When a signal is supplied from the ALARM/CON-  
TROL connector on the rear panel the external  
recording mode changeover terminal (pin no. 24) of  
the unit will work with the set timetable for "EXT."  
[Time Table] Assignment of REC Program  
and Event Program after setting the time  
zone  
Create recording timetables for each day of the week, and  
assign REC Program and Event Program to each timetable.  
Up to 6 recording programs can be created.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The pop-up settings menu of the timetable for the selected  
day of the week will be displayed.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
12AM  
12AM  
6AM  
12PM  
6PM  
Maintenance  
Time Table (MON)  
Copy the Other Time Table  
New Time Table Setup  
Recording  
Event  
Time Table  
SETUP MENU  
MON  
TUE  
WED  
THU  
FRI  
LIVE  
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
TUE  
Time Table  
Period 1  
Period 2  
Period 3  
Period 4  
Period 5  
Period 6  
12  
08  
12  
01  
05  
09  
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM  
00 AM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
08  
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM  
00 PM  
REC Progra
Event Progr
Special Da
12  
01  
05  
09  
12  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 AM  
SAT  
SUN  
DAILY  
EXT  
O K  
CANCEL  
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT  
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4  
REC  
P1  
P2  
P3  
P4  
EVT  
P1  
P2  
P3  
P4  
Do the following to create timetables.  
c Select "New Time Table Setup" using the arrows button  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation after displaying the timetable window.  
(CD) and rotate the jog dial to check the radio button.  
[Screenshot 4]  
The radio button for "New Time Table Setup" is checked.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
12AM  
12AM  
6AM  
12PM  
6PM  
Time Table  
MON  
TUE  
WED  
THU  
FRI  
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
Recording  
Copy the Other Time Table  
Event  
SETUP MENU Maintenance  
LIVE  
Time Table (MON)  
TUE  
New Time Table Setup  
Time Table  
Period 1  
Period 2  
Period 3  
Period 4  
Period 5  
Period 6  
12  
08  
12  
01  
05  
09  
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM  
00 AM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
08  
:
:
:
:
:
:
00 AM  
00 PM  
REC Program  
Event Progra
Special Day
12  
01  
05  
09  
12  
SAT  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 PM  
00 AM  
SUN  
DAILY  
EXT  
O K  
CANCEL  
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT  
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4  
REC  
P1  
P2  
P3  
P4  
EVT  
P1  
P2  
P3  
P4  
z Press the SET button.  
v Move the cursor to the start time input box for "Period 1"  
using the arrows button.  
b Rotate the jog dial to set the start time.  
The end time can be set in the same way.  
Repeat steps 4 and 5 to set for "Period 2" - "Period 6".  
(It is not necessary to set for all of "Period 1" - "Period  
6".)  
108  
n Select OK using the arrows button and press the SET  
[Special Days] Perform the settings for  
button.  
recording programs for special days  
Assign timetables to special days aside from other days of  
the week. Timetables for special days can be set for up to  
30 days.  
Perform the settings to specify dates as special days and  
apply the recording schedule to the special days.  
Notes:  
The start time and end time can be set in 15 min-  
utes intervals.  
To copy a timetable that is set for a different day of  
the week, select "Copy the Other Time Table" and  
select a day of the week by rotating the jog dial in  
step 3.  
Then, move the cursor to the "day of the week" box,  
press the arrows button (B) and select a day of the  
week by rotating the jog dial. After selecting, move  
the cursor to OK and press the SET button.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Time Table  
DATE  
MODE  
SUN 16 --  
DATE  
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
MODE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
1
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
1
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
REC Program  
Event Program  
Special Days  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
[Screenshot 5]  
The settings are applied to the selected timetable and the  
timetable for all the days of the week will be displayed.  
Maintenance  
Recording  
Event  
12PM  
SETUP MENU  
12AM  
12AM  
6AM  
6PM  
REC  
EVT  
MON  
Time Table  
REC  
EVT  
TUE  
WED  
THU  
FRI  
REC Progra
Event Progr
Special Da
REC  
EVT  
REC  
EVT  
REC  
EVT  
REC  
EVT  
SAT  
SUN  
DAILY  
EXT  
REC  
EVT  
REC  
EVT  
REC  
EVT  
OK  
REC PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4 EVT  
CANCEL  
PROG1 PROG2 PROG3 PROG4  
m Move the cursor to the time zone of the day of the week  
to which the REC program is to be assigned using the  
arrows button.  
, Rotate the jog dial to select a desired REC program/  
Event program.  
(Rotating the jog dial changes the displayed REC pro-  
gram.)  
REC program will be displayed with different colours.  
Yellow: REC program 1/Event program 1  
Green: REC program 2/Event program 2  
Pale purple: REC program 3/Event program 3  
Indigo blue: REC program 4/Event program 4  
It is possible to display the assigned REC Program/  
Event Program window (pages 105 and 107) by press-  
ing the SET button.  
Repeat steps 7 and 8 to assign REC program to other  
timetables.  
. Move the cursor to OK using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
The REC program/Event program will be assigned  
to the selected time zone and the selected  
timetable window will be closed.  
Note: When the SET button is pressed after moving the  
cursor to CANCEL in step 9, the settings will be  
canceled and the selected timetable window will be  
closed.  
109  
I [Switcher] Settings for the switcher function  
Perform the settings for image switching such as the  
sequential display setting or the waiting screen (while log-  
ging out) setting for displaying on monitors 1 and 2.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The "Live Sequence" pop-up menu will be displayed.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DWELL  
LIVE  
1
2
3
4
2s  
1
--  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
9
9
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
2
--  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
2s  
2s  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
Live Sequence  
I
I
I
I
I
SETUP  
3
--  
Sequence Timing  
Auto Skip  
INT  
4
5
6
7
8
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
2s  
OFF  
CAM1  
5
6
7
8
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
Login Screen  
Secret View  
OFF  
OK  
CANCEL  
x Move the cursor to "CAM" of "STEP 1" using the arrows  
button.  
[Monitor 1] Switcher function of monitor 1  
Perform the settings for the switcher function of monitor 1.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The cursor moves to "CAM".  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
Live Sequence  
I
I
I
I
I
SETUP  
Sequence Timing  
Auto Skip  
INT  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DWELL  
OFF  
CAM1  
1
2
3
4
2s  
1
--  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
9
9
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
Login Screen  
Secret View  
2
--  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
2s  
OFF  
2s  
3
--  
4
5
6
7
8
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
2s  
5
6
7
8
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
OK  
CANCEL  
8Live Sequence  
c Select how to display images from camera channels in  
"STEP 1" from the following by rotating the jog dial.  
1, 2, ... , 16: Displays an image from the selected cam-  
era channel on a single screen.  
Perform the settings for the sequential display of live  
images as follows.  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the "Monitor1" menu of "Switcher" on  
the SETUP MENU.  
1 - 4: Displays images from camera channels  
1 - 4 on a 4-split screen.  
5 - 8: Displays images from camera channels  
5 - 8 on a 4-split screen.  
9-9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from  
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split  
screen.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
Live Sequence  
I
I
I
I
I
SETUP  
Sequence Timing  
Auto Skip  
INT  
OFF  
CAM1  
Login Screen  
Secret View  
OFF  
9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images from  
camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split screen.  
13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images from  
camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split screen.  
1 - 9: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 9 on a  
9-split screen.  
10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images from  
camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split screen.  
--: Skips the selected step.  
z Move the cursor to "Live Sequence" using the arrows  
button (CD) and press the SET button.  
v When displaying images from camera channels "1 - 16"  
on a single screen is selected in step 3, select the cam-  
era position.  
Move the cursor to "PRESET" in "STEP 1" using the  
arrows button.  
110  
[Screenshot 4]  
The cursor moves to the "PRESET" in "STEP 1".  
8Auto Skip  
Select ON of OFF to determine whether or not to skip the  
camera channel without supplying the video input signal  
because it is not connected, etc.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
ON: Skips a channel if it is not connected.  
OFF: Displays a black screen for a channel not connected.  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DW
E
LL
1
1
1
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
9
1-8  
9-16  
11  
-- 2s  
2s  
2
2
1
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
3
3
64  
2s  
2s  
4
4
5
--  
--  
--  
--  
12  
5
6
7
8
1-4  
1-4  
5-8  
9-12  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
5-8  
9-12  
13-16  
8Login Screen  
16 13-16  
OK  
CANCEL  
Select a camera image to be displayed during the login  
procedure from the following.  
CAM1 - 16: Displays an image from the selected camera  
channel.  
QUAD1 - 4: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 4  
on a 4-split screen.  
QUAD5 - 8: Displays images from camera channels 5 - 8  
on a 4-split screen.  
QUAD9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from  
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split  
screen.  
b Rotate the jog dial to select a preset position number  
for which image is displayed in "STEP 1" from the follow-  
ing.  
1 - 64: Moves to the selected preset number.  
--: Does not move to the preset position.  
n Select "DWELL" in "STEP 1" using the arrows button.  
QUAD9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split screen.  
QUAD13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split screen.  
7SCREEN: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 7 on  
a 7-split screen.  
9SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image  
from camera channel 1 - 9 on the upper left area on a  
9-split screen.  
[Screenshot 5]  
The cursor moves to"DWELL" in "STEP 1".  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
STEP CAM PRESET DWELL STEP CAM PRESET DW
E
LL
1
1
1
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
9
1-8  
9-16  
11  
-- 2s  
2
2s  
2
1
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
3
3
64  
2s  
2s  
4
4
5
--  
--  
--  
--  
12  
5
6
7
8
1-4  
1-4  
5-8  
9-12  
2s  
2s  
2s  
2s  
5-8  
9-12  
13-16  
16 13-16  
OK  
CANCEL  
9SCREEN1 - 9 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 9 on a 9-split screen.  
9SCREEN10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays  
images from camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split  
screen.  
10SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 10 on a 10-split screen.  
13SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 13 on a 13-split screen.  
16SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 16 on a 16-split screen.  
--: No camera image will be displayed (black screen)  
m Rotate the jog dial to select an interval time to go to the  
next sequential step from 1 - 30 seconds (in 1 second  
intervals).  
The sequence step is skipped when "0 s" is selected.  
Repeat steps 2 and 7 to set for the other sequence  
steps.  
, Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
The settings for the sequential display are set and  
the sequence setting menu closes.  
8Secret View  
The secret view is a function to display a black screen on  
monitor 1 when camera images are displayed with a single  
screen on monitor 2. Select ON or OFF to determine  
whether to enable or disable the secret view function.  
ON: Enables the secret view function. (Camera images dis-  
played with a single screen on monitor 2 will be dis-  
played while monitor 1 has a black screen.)  
Note: If you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 8 and  
press the SET button, the setting will be canceled  
and the sequence setting menu will be closed.  
8Sequence Timing  
OFF: Disables the secret view function.  
Select an image switching method from the following.  
INT: Switches images according to the settings for the live  
sequence.  
EXT: Switches images by signals from an external device.  
MON 2: Match with the image switching timing of the live  
sequence on monitor 2.  
111  
[Monitor 2] Switcher function of monitor 2  
Perform the settings for the switcher function of monitor 2.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
Live Sequence  
Sequence Timing  
Auto Skip  
I
I
I
I
SETUP  
INT  
OFF  
CAM1  
Login Screen  
8Live Sequence  
The settings for "Live Sequence" are the same as for  
"Monitor1". Refer to page 110 for further information.  
8Sequence Timing  
The settings for "Sequence Timing" are the same as for  
"Monitor1". Refer to page 111 for further information.  
Notes:  
Select "EXT" when an external device that can transmit  
a sequence signal is connected.  
The sequence changeover I/O (pin no.21) of the  
ALARM/CONTROL connector on the rear panel will  
supply signals when "INT" is selected and will receive  
signals when "EXT" is selected.  
8Auto Skip  
The settings for "Auto Skip" are the same as for "Monitor1".  
Refer to page 111 for further information.  
8Login Screen  
The settings for "Login Screen" are the same as for  
"Monitor1". Refer to page 111 for further information.  
112  
I [Display]  
Perform the display settings for monitors 1 and 2 connected  
to the unit.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The camera title pop-up window will be displayed.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
LIVE  
Camera Title  
SETUP  
L-UPPER  
R-LOWER  
WHITE  
I
I
I
I
OSD Setup  
OSD Setup  
Time & Date Display Position  
Camera Title Display Position  
Line Color on the Multi Screen  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
OK  
CANCEL  
x Move the cursor to "CAM1" using the arrows button.  
OSD Setup  
[Screenshot 3]  
The cursor moves to " CAM1".  
Perform the On Screen Display settings for monitor 1 and  
monitor 2 such as the settings of camera titles or the set-  
tings of the time display position.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
CAM1
OSD Setu
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
CAM1  
SETUP MENU  
CAM2
LIVE  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM3  
Camera Title  
SETUP  
L-UPPER  
R-LOWER  
WHITE  
I
I
I
I
OSD Setup  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
Time & Date Display Position  
Camera Title Display Position  
Line Color on the Multi Screen  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
OK  
CANCEL  
c Select a character to be entered by rotating the jog dial.  
Up to 16 characters can be entered.  
8Camera Title  
Perform the settings for the camera title. It is possible to  
display a camera title on the monitor 1/monitor 2, and  
record it as a part of the recorded image (page 98). Do the  
following to set the camera title.  
v Move the cursor to the right side of the entered charac-  
ter using the arrows button.  
Repeat steps 3 and 4 to enter the camera title.  
Notes:  
[Screenshot 1]  
To correct the entered characters, move the cursor  
to the character to be corrected and press the  
STOP button to delete it. Enter a correct character  
after deleting.  
To copy the camera title that has been set for  
another camera channel, follow the procedure  
below.  
Start operation from the "OSD Setup" menu.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Camera Title  
SETUP  
L-UPPER  
R-LOWER  
WHITE  
I
I
I
I
OSD Setup  
Time & Date Display Position  
Camera Title Display Position  
Line Color on the Multi Screen  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
1. Move the cursor to "CAM 1" in step 2 on the pre-  
vious page and press the SET button. The fol-  
lowing screen will be displayed.  
SETU
CAM2  
Copy Another Camera Title  
I
LIVE  
z Move the cursor to "Camera Title" using the arrows but-  
P  
Comm
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
ton (C D) and press the SET button.  
Monito
Monito
O K  
CANCEL  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
OK  
CANCEL  
2. Select the camera channel for which the cam-  
era title is to be copied by rotating the jog dial.  
113  
3. Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button  
and press the SET button. The camera title will  
be copied.  
Notes:  
When setting the time and date to be recorded together  
with images, the time display will be recorded in the  
selected position.  
Refer to page 98 for further information about  
"Embedded REC (Time & Date)".  
The following characters can be entered for a cam-  
era title:  
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P  
Q R S T U V W X Y Z a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r  
s t u v w x y z À Ä Â Æ Ç É Ì Ñ Ò Ö Ù Ü Ø ß à á â ä  
å æ ç è é ê ë ì í î ï ñ ò ó ô ö ù ú ü ø < > = ? # & ( )  
* + , - . / : ; SP  
8Camera Title Display Position  
Select a camera title display position from the following.  
L-UPPER: Displays the camera title at the upper left of the  
screen.  
[Screenshot 4]  
The camera title is entered.  
L-LOWER: Displays the camera title at the lower left of the  
screen.  
R-UPPER: Displays the camera title at the upper right of  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
the screen.  
LIVE  
R-LOWER: Displays the camera title at the lower right of  
OSD Setup  
CAM1CAM1
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
CAM2  
ENTRANCE  
the screen.  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
CENTRE: Displays the camera title at the centre of the  
screen.  
OK  
CANCEL  
Note: When setting the camera title to be recorded togeth-  
er with images, the time display will be embedded in  
the selected position.  
Refer to page 98 for further information about  
"Embedded REC (title)".  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
OSD Setup  
LIVE  
CAM9CAM9
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
CAM10  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
8Line Colour on the Multi Screen  
Select a line colour from the following.  
WHITE: Displays white lines.  
GREY: Displays grey lines.  
OK  
CANCEL  
BLACK: Displays black lines.  
b Press the arrows button to move the cursor to "OK" and  
press the SET button.  
[Monitor 1] Settings on monitor 1 display  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the time, cam-  
era title and alarm display on monitor 1.  
The camera title will be set and the setting window  
of the camera title will be closed.  
Notes:  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
If you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 5 and  
press the SET button, the setting will be canceled  
and the setting window of the camera title will be  
closed.  
LIVE  
ON  
ON  
ON  
Time & Date Display  
Camera Title Display  
Alarm Display  
OSD Setup  
I
I
I
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
It is possible to set "Camera Title [Display]" to dis-  
play a camera title on monitor 2 and "Camera Title  
[Embedded]" to embed/display a camera title on  
monitor 1 individually using a PC via a network.  
Refer to the Network Setup Instruction (PDF) for fur-  
ther information.  
8Time & Date Display  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the time.  
ON: Displays time.  
8Time & Date Display Position  
OFF: Does not function.  
Select a time and date display position from the following.  
L-UPPER: Displays the time at the upper left of the screen.  
R-UPPER: Displays the time at the upper right of the  
screen.  
L-LOWER: Displays the time at the lower left of the screen.  
R-LOWER: Displays the time at the lower right of the  
screen.  
114  
8Camera Title Display  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the camera  
title.  
ON: Displays the camera title.  
OFF: Does not function.  
8Alarm Display  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to activate the alarm dis-  
play at an event occurrence.  
ON: Displays the alarm display at an event occurrence.  
OFF: Does not function.  
[Monitor2] Settings on monitor 2 display  
Perform the display settings for monitor 2 such as the dis-  
play mode (task bar style), time display position on/off,  
camera title display position, etc.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Display Mode  
T&D and Status Display Position  
Camera Title Display  
MODE  
LOWER  
ON  
1
I
I
I
OSD Setup  
Monitor  
Monitor  
1
2
The following explain the settings for monitor 2 and the VGA  
monitor such as the display mode (task bar style), time dis-  
play position, camera title display ON/OFF, etc.  
8Display Mode  
Select a display mode (task bar style) from the following.  
Refer to page 11 for further information about the task bar.  
MODE 1: Select [MODE 1] for the display mode.  
MODE 2: Select [MODE 2] for the display mode.  
MODE 3: Select [MODE 3] for the display mode.  
8T & D and Status Display Position  
When selecting MODE 1, select the position of the time and  
date display and the status from the following.  
UPPER: Displays them in the upper part of the screen.  
LOWER: Displays them in the lower part of the screen.  
8Camera Title Display  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to display the camera  
title.  
ON: Displays the camera title.  
OFF: Does not function.  
115  
I [Comm] Settings for communication with other devices  
It is necessary to adjust the communication speed and use  
the same communication protocol with external devices  
such as a controller when connecting those external  
devices to the DATA port or the SERIAL connector  
(RS232C).  
To prevent operation mistakes, set the unused camera  
channels to off.  
It is possible to compensate for the video signal trans-  
mission loss from the camera when using the VIDEO IN  
connector 1 - 8. (cable compensation)  
It is also necessary to perform the settings for the network  
such as the IP address and the gateway address when  
operating this unit a PC via a network such as a LAN.  
These are the descriptions of how to perform the required  
settings for communication with external devices.  
Perform the settings for the cable compensation  
according to the length of cable used.  
S: When the length of cable used is shorter than 500 m  
M: When the length of cable used is longer than 500 m  
and shorter than 900 m  
L: When the length of cable used is longer than 900 m  
and shorter than 1 200 m  
[Camera Control] Settings for the communi-  
cation method and the cable compensation  
for camera control  
Select a communication method for each camera channel  
to control cameras from the following.  
Notes:  
Use 5C-2V cables for the cable compensation.  
Perform the settings for the cable compensation prop-  
erly according to the cable length. Otherwise camera  
pictures may not be displayed/recorded correctly.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Camera Control  
PS.Data Setup  
RS485 Setup  
Type of Camera Control  
I
[PS.Data Setup] Settings for the PS·Data  
Perform the following settings for the PS·Data.  
CAM  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
COMP  
TYPE  
COAX  
COAX  
COAX  
COAX  
COAX  
COAX  
COAX  
COAX  
CAM  
TYPE  
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
CAM9  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
RS232C Setup  
PSD  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
NTP Setup  
RS485  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
001  
001  
OFF  
9600  
8
Camera Control  
PS.DATA Setup  
RS485 Setup  
Unit Address(System)  
Unit Address(Controller)  
Cascade  
Baud Rate  
Data Bit  
Parity  
Stop Bit  
Retry Timing  
Alarm Data  
Camera Number Setup  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
RS232C Setup  
NONE  
1
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
OFF  
1s  
NTP Setup  
COAX: Controls camera with the coaxial communication  
(CAM 1 - 8 CH are available for the WJ-HD316, CAM 1 -  
6 CH are available for the WJ-HD309)  
SETUP  
PSD: Controls camera with the PS·Data. (CAM 9 - 16 CH  
are available for the WJ-HD316, CAM 7 - 9 CH are  
available for the WJ-HD309)  
8Unit Address (System)  
RS485: Controls camera with the RS485 communication.  
(CAM 1 - 16 CH are available for the WJ-HD316, CAM 1  
- 9 CH are available for the WJ-HD309)  
OFF: Does not control camera (CAM 1 - 16 CH are avail-  
able)  
A unit address (System) is a unique number assigning to  
PS·Data devices. The addresses must be unique to identify  
system devices when connecting multiple devices compati-  
ble with PS·Data. Numbers, "001"-"099", are to be assigned  
as the unit addresses to the system devices.  
Notes:  
8Unit Address (Controller)  
Perform settings according to the cameras connected  
to this unit.  
CAM 9-16 control 4 cameras each (only for the WJ-  
HD316).  
The unit address (controller) is used to control a PS·Data  
device connected to this unit. Numbers, "001" - "099" are to  
be assigned.  
When using the coaxial communication to control cam-  
eras, connect cameras to the VIDEO IN connectors 1 -  
8 for the WJ-HD316 (1 - 6 for the WJ-HD309) (coaxial  
communication compatible). When controlling cameras  
connected to other VIDEO IN connectors with coaxial  
communication, use a coaxial communication unit (WJ-  
MP204). In this case, select "PSD" for the communica-  
tion method for the camera channels to be controlled  
through the coaxial communication unit.  
8Cascade  
Select ON or OFF whether or not to use the cascade con-  
nection.  
Set this to ON when connecting two or more units or in the  
cascade connection.  
ON: Select this when connecting units in the cascade con-  
nection.  
OFF: Does not function.  
116  
[Screenshot 2]  
8Baud Rate  
The "Camera Number Setup" pop-up window will be dis-  
played.  
Select the communication speed for data transmission with  
a connected device from the following.  
2 400/4 800/9 600/19 200/38 400 bps  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Camera Number Setup  
CI
Camera  
8Data Bit  
CAM PORT  
CAM NO.  
001  
CAM PORT CAM NO.  
PS.DATA  
RS485 Se
1
9
009  
010  
2
002  
003  
004  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
RS232C S
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.  
8 bit  
3
011  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
4
012  
013  
5
005  
NTP Setu
6
006  
014
015  
016  
7
007  
008  
8
8Parity  
O K  
CANCEL  
Select a method to check a transmission error at communi-  
cation from the following.  
NONE: No parity check  
EVEN: Even parity  
ODD: Odd parity  
x Move the cursor to a desired "CAM No." of "CAM PORT"  
using the arrows button.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The cursor will move to the selected "CAM No." of "CAM  
PORT".  
8Stop Bit  
Select a stop bit from the following.  
1 bit/2 bit  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
8Retry Timing  
Camera Number Setup  
CI
Camera  
CAM PORT  
CAM NO.  
001  
CAM PORT CAM NO.  
PS.DATA  
RS485 Se
RS232C S
1
9
009  
010  
Select a retransmission interval for when data reception is  
not confirmed from the following.  
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1 000 ms  
2
002  
003  
004  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
3
011  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
4
012  
013  
5
005  
NTP Setu
6
006  
014
015  
016  
7
007  
008  
8
O K  
CANCEL  
8Alarm Data  
Select a method to inform the connected controller of an  
event occurrence from the following.  
OFF: Does not function.  
0 s: Informs the controller every time an event is detected.  
1 s/5 s: Informs the controller when a specified time has  
passed after detecting an event.  
c Select a camera number by rotating the jog dial.  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to assign camera numbers to the  
other CAM PORT.  
v Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
8Camera Number Setup  
Camera numbers will be assigned and the "Camera  
Number Setup" menu will be closed.  
It is possible to assign a number to each camera channel to  
operate cameras using the controller compatible with  
PS·Data.  
Note: When you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 4  
and press the SET button, the settings will be can-  
celed and the "Camera Number Setup" menu will be  
closed.  
Do the following to assign numbers to the camera chan-  
nels.  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the "PS·Data Setup" menu.  
[RS485 Setup] Settings for RS485  
Perform the following settings for RS485.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
001  
001  
OFF  
9600  
8
Camera Control  
PS.DATA Setup  
RS485 Setup  
Unit Address(System)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Unit Address(Controller)  
Cascade  
Baud Rate  
RS232C Setup  
Data Bit  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU Maintenance  
Switcher  
NONE  
1
LIVE  
Parity  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
Stop Bit  
OFF  
1s  
Retry Timing  
Alarm Data  
Camera Control  
PS.DATA Setup  
RS485 Setup  
19200  
Baud Rate  
Control Camera CH  
Data Bit  
Parity  
Stop Bit  
I
I
I
I
I
NTP Setup  
SETUP  
SETUP  
Camera Number Setup  
8
NONE  
1
RS232C Setup  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
NTP Setup  
z Move the cursor to "Camera Number Setup" using the  
arrows button (C D) and press the SET button.  
117  
v Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
8Baud Rate  
Select the communication speed for data transmission with  
a connected device from the following.  
4 800/9 600/19 200 bps  
Camera channels and ports to be controlled will be  
assigned and the "Control Camera CH" menu will be  
closed.  
8Control Camera CH  
Notes:  
It is possible to assign camera channels to the RS485 ports  
1 and 2 as shown below.  
When you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 4  
and press the SET button, the settings will be can-  
celed and the "Camera Number Setup" menu will be  
closed.  
The unit number of the camera will be congruent  
with the camera number.  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the "RS485 Setup" menu.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Camera Control  
PS.DATA Setup  
RS485 Setup  
19200  
Baud Rate  
Control Camera CH  
Data Bit  
Parity  
Stop Bit  
I
I
I
I
I
8Data Bit  
SETUP  
8
NONE  
1
The data length for communication will be displayed.  
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.  
RS232C Setup  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
NTP Setup  
8Parity  
Methods to check a transmission error at communication  
will be displayed.  
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.  
z Move the cursor to "Control Camera CH" using the  
arrows button (CD) and press the SET button.  
8Stop Bit  
[Screenshot 2]  
The "Control Camera CH" pop-up window will be displayed.  
Number of stop bit will be displayed.  
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Control Camera CH  
[RS232C Setup] Settings for RS232C  
Perform the following settings for RS232C.  
CI
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
Camera  
PS.DATA
RS485 S
CAMERA  
TERM  
PORT1  
PORT1  
CAMERA  
CAM9  
TERM  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
RS232C
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
PORT1  
NW Setu
NW Setu
PORT1  
PORT1  
PORT1  
PORT1  
PORT1  
NTP Setu
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Camera Control  
PS.DATA Setup  
RS485 Setup  
Unit Address(System)  
Baud Rate  
Data Bit  
Parity  
Stop Bit  
I
I
I
I
I
I
O K  
CANCEL  
001  
9600  
8
NONE  
1
RS232C Setup  
OFF  
Retry Timing  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
NTP Setup  
x Move the cursor to a desired cell in the "TERM" column  
using the arrows button.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The cursor will move to the selected cell in the "TERM" col-  
umn.  
8Unit Address(System)  
A unit address (System) is a unique number assigned to  
each system device. The addresses must be unique to  
identify system devices when connecting multiple system  
devices.  
Numbers, "001"-"099", are to be assigned as the unit  
addresses for the system devices.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Control Camera CH  
CI
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
PORT2  
Camera  
PS.DATA
RS485 S
CAMERA  
TERM  
PORT1  
PORT1  
CAMERA  
CAM9  
TERM  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM10  
CAM11  
CAM12  
CAM13  
CAM14  
CAM15  
CAM16  
RS232C
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
PORT1  
NW Setu
NW Setu
PORT1  
PORT1  
PORT1  
PORT1  
PORT1  
NTP Setu
8Baud Rate  
O K  
CANCEL  
Select the communication speed for data transmission with  
a connected device from the following.  
9 600/19 200/38 400 bps  
c Select a port by rotating the jog dial.  
PORT 1: Control through the RS485 port 1.  
PORT 2: Control through the RS485 port 2.  
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to assign other camera channels  
to be controlled through the RS485 ports.  
118  
8Data Bit  
8Host Authentication  
Select a data length for communication from the following.  
7/8 bit  
Select ON or OFF whether or not to restrict access by IP  
addresses at the time of access from a PC to this unit.  
When ON is selected, only PCs with registered IP address  
can access this unit  
8Parity  
ON: Activates host authentication.  
OFF: Does not function.  
Select a method to check a transmission error at communi-  
cation from the following.  
NONE: No parity check  
EVEN: Even parity  
ODD: Odd parity  
Note: When ON is selected for both the user authentication  
and the host authentication, it is possible to operate the  
unit only from a registered host. Operable functions will  
differ depending on the user level setting of the authen-  
ticated user. It is impossible to operate the unit from an  
unregistered host.  
8Stop Bit  
Select a stop bit from the following.  
1/2 bit  
8Line Speed  
8Retry Timing  
The line speed will be displayed.  
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.  
Select a retransmission interval for when data reception is  
not confirmed from the following.  
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1 000 ms  
8Live Video Quality  
Image quality level for a live (FQB: high quality) will be dis-  
played.  
It is impossible to change the value for this setting.  
[NW Setup 1] Basic network settings  
Perform the following basic network settings to operate this  
unit using a PC via a network such as a LAN.  
[NW Setup 2] Network connection settings  
Perform the following network connection settings to oper-  
ate this unit using a PC via a network such as a LAN.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
HTTP Port Number  
User Authentication  
Host Authentication  
Line Speed  
00080  
OFF  
OFF  
AUTO  
FQB  
Camera Control  
PS.Data Setup  
RS485 Setup  
I
I
I
I
I
RS232C Setup  
Live Video Quality  
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
NTP Setup  
LIVE  
Camera Control  
PS.Data Setup  
RS485 Setup  
DHCP  
OFF  
I
I
I
I
I
192  
255  
192  
168  
255  
168  
000  
250  
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Gateway  
DNS  
Primary  
Secondary  
DDNS  
User Name  
User Password  
Access Interval  
Host Name  
HD316  
255  
000  
000  
001  
RS232C Setup  
MANUAL  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
000  
.
.
.
.
.
.
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
000  
000  
OFF  
I
NTP Setup  
10m  
I
I
8HTTP Port Number  
Domain Name  
localdomain  
Specify the HTTP port number to be used to transfer  
images from this unit. It is not necessary to change it for  
normal use.  
8DHCP  
Select ON or OFF whether or not to use the DHCP server.  
When obtaining IP addresses, net mask and a gateway  
address from the DHCP server, set to ON.  
If not, set to OFF and enter those addresses manually.  
ON: Uses the DHCP server.  
8User Authentication  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to activate user authenti-  
cation at the time of access from a PC to this unit.  
When ON is selected, the user authentication (login) win-  
dow will be displayed at the time of access from a PC.  
The top page will be displayed if the entered user name  
and password are registered.  
OFF: Does not use the DHCP server.  
8IP Address  
ON: Activates user authentication.  
OFF: Does not function.  
Enter an IP address when OFF is selected for "DHCP".  
For this unit, enter 4 units of the decimal number (0-254).  
Note: It is recommended to select ON for the user authenti-  
8Subnet Mask  
cation for security.  
Enter a subnet mask according to the network configuration  
when OFF is selected for "DHCP".  
8Gateway  
Enter the gateway address according to the network con-  
figuration when OFF is selected for "DHCP".  
119  
8DNS  
8Time Zone  
Select "MANUAL" or "AUTO" to enable searching for an IP  
address by its host name using DNS. When "OFF" is select-  
ed for "DHCP" (no use of the DHCP server), select "MANU-  
AL" and enter the domain name and the DNS server  
address. If "ON" is selected for "DHCP" (use of the DHCP  
server), select "AUTO". When DNS is not used, select "OFF".  
When "MANUAL" is selected for DNS, enter the DNS server  
address for "Primary" and "Secondary".  
Set the time zone in accordance with the place of use when  
using the NTP server for time adjustment.  
8NTP Server Address  
Enter the NTP server address when using the NTP server  
for time adjustment.  
8Refresh Interval  
Select an interval of time inquiry to be transmitted to the  
NTP server from the following.  
1 h/2 h/6 h/12 h/24 h  
8DDNS  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to use the DDNS  
(Dynamic Domain Name Server).  
Selecting ON is available only when "MANUAL" or "AUTO" is  
selected for "DNS".  
Important:  
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds  
When "ON" is selected, perform the following.  
User Name: Enter the user name registered in "DDNS".  
Password: Enter the password for the user entered in  
"User Name".  
when changing the present time (accurate to within  
seconds) using "Time Adjustment".  
5
Access Interval: Select an interval to update DNS from the  
following.  
10 m/30 m/1 h/6 h/24 h  
8Host Name  
Enter the host address registered in DDNS.  
Enter a host name of no more than 255 alphanumeric char-  
acters. Hyphens (-) are also available for the host name.  
8Domain Name  
Enter the domain name of this unit.  
Enter a domain name of no more than 255 alphanumeric  
characters. Hyphens (-) are also available for the domain  
name.  
[NTP Setup] Time adjustment of network  
Perform the following settings for time adjustment.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
OFF  
Camera Control  
PS.DATA Setup  
RS485 Setup  
Time Adjustment  
Time Zone  
NTP Server Address  
I
I
I
GMTT10:000  
RS232C Setup  
6h  
Refresh Interval  
I
NW Setup  
NW Setup  
1
2
NTP Setup  
8Time Adjustment  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to adjust the time with  
reference to the NTP server.  
ON: Adjusts time with reference to the NTP server.  
OFF: Does not function.  
Note: Time adjustment will be performed automatically  
when the clock time is inaccurate to within 5 seconds  
from the standard time of the NTP server.  
120  
I [System] Settings on System  
Perform the following system settings required to operate  
this unit.  
OFF: Does not activate the auto logout function.  
1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m/30 m: Activates the auto logout func-  
tion when the selected time has passed after login.  
Important:  
[Basic Setup] Basic system settings  
The auto logout function will not be activated when ON  
is selected for "Auto Login".  
Perform the following settings for basic operation.  
Depending on the user level of the auto login user,  
operable functions may be different.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Basic Setup  
ADMIN Password  
*****  
PSD User  
ADMIN  
Auto Login  
Auto Login User  
I
I
I
Time  
&
Date  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
ON  
8Priority  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
ADMIN  
Auto Logout  
Priority  
"GO TO LAST" before  
Language  
Beep(Operation)  
Buzzer(Error)  
Shutdown Time  
Auto Copy  
OFF  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Assign operating priorities when multiple users access this  
unit simultaneously from the following.  
Follow the priority: Operation by a user with a higher pri-  
ority will be performed. When the priorities of the first  
and the last accessed user are the same, post-priority  
will be applied.  
Follow the priority.  
5s  
ENGLISH  
ON  
2s  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
10s  
OFF  
8ADMIN Password  
Pre-priority: Operation by the first accessed user will be  
performed regardless of priority.  
Post-priority: Operation by the last accessed user will be  
performed regardless of priority.  
Set the password for an administrator.  
Enter 4-8 alphanumeric characters.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete char-  
acters as for attaching text information to images. Refer to  
page 55 about the characters available.  
8"GO TO LAST" before  
Select time to be skipped to when the "GO TO LAST" button  
is pressed during playback from the following.  
5 s/10 s/30 s/1 m/5 m  
Important:  
To enhance the security, change the password for an  
administrator periodically.  
8Language  
8PSD User  
Select a language for the SETUP MENU from the following.  
JAPANESE/ENGLISH/FRANÇAIS/ESPAÑOL/DEUTSCH/  
ITALIANO  
When a user operates a controller compatible with PS·Data,  
operation will be restricted by the priority and operational  
level of the PSD user.  
A PSD user should be one of the users registered in this  
unit.  
Important:  
Displaying the language of the browser used to access  
the unit from a PC will not be changed even though this  
setting is changed.  
8Auto Login  
Select ON and OFF whether or not to activate the auto login  
function.  
ON: Activates the auto login function.  
OFF: Does not activate the auto login function. It is neces-  
sary to perform the login operation every time this unit is  
started up.  
8Beep (Operation)  
Select ON or OFF whether or not to sound the buzzer when  
operating the buttons.  
ON: Sounds the buzzer when operating the buttons.  
OFF: Does not sound the buzzer when operating the but-  
tons.  
8Auto Login User  
When ON is selected for "Auto Login", the user registered  
as an auto login user in this setting can log into the unit  
automatically.  
An auto login user should be one of the users registered in  
this unit.  
8Buzzer (Error)  
Select a buzzer operation when a problem has occurred  
from the following.  
OFF: Does not sound buzzer when a problem has  
occurred.  
1 s - 30 s (in 1 second intervals)/40 s/50 s/1 m/1 m/3 m/  
4 m/5 m (in 1 minute intervals): A buzzer will sound  
for the selected duration after a problem has occurred.  
EXT: The buzzer will sound continuously until the "ALARM  
RESET" button on the front panel of the unit is pressed.  
8Auto Logout  
Select ON or OFF whether or not to activate the auto logout  
function.  
When ON is selected, auto logout will be carried out after a  
specified time has passed while displaying live images  
without operation.  
121  
8Shutdown Time  
8Time Setup  
Select a waiting time before starting the internal processing  
against the power outage after an outage detection signal  
has been supplied to the unit from the following.  
10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m  
Adjust the current time and date.  
Enter year, month, day, hour, minute and second in order,  
move the cursor to "SET" and press the SET button.  
Important:  
8Auto Copy  
Recording will stop for around 4 seconds just after set-  
ting the date and time.  
ON or OFF whether or not to copy recorded images to the  
copy area on the hard disk automatically.  
OFF: Does not copy automatically.  
8Auto Adjust Time  
ON: Copies recorded images to the copy area on the hard  
disk of this unit.  
Select a method for auto time adjustment from the follow-  
ing.  
When "MASTER" is selected, a signal will be supplied from  
the ALARM/CONTROL connector as the MASTER time (see  
below) at the specified time.  
Important:  
When OFF is selected, the auto copy function at an  
event occurrence and emergency recording will not  
function.  
The auto copy will not work if a DVD-RAM disk drive is  
not connected even though "COPY 1" or "COPY 2" is  
selected.  
OFF: Does not function.  
MASTER: A signal will be supplied from the ALARM/CON-  
TROL connector on the rear and the clock of the other  
devices will be adjusted with reference to the time of  
this unit.  
Images recorded (by pre-event recording) in the pre-  
recording area in the extension unit will not be copied  
automatically.  
SLAVE: A signal will be supplied to the ALARM/CONTROL  
connector on the rear and the clock of this unit will be  
adjusted.  
When emergency recording/event recordings are per-  
formed frequently, it may be possible that the auto copy  
function does not function.  
Important:  
Recording will not be performed for around 4 seconds  
Images to be copied automatically will be 30 minutes  
worth of images recorded from the start of emergency  
recording/event recording.  
when changing the present time (accurate to within  
seconds) using the time adjustment input (pin no.20) of  
the ALARM/CONTROL connector on the rear panel.  
5
8Master Time  
[Time & Date] Setting of the date and time  
Perform the following settings of the time and date.  
Specify the time when supplying a signal from the  
ALARM/CONTROL connector.  
8Summer Time (Day Light Saving)  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Select the method of switching to summer time from the fol-  
lowing.  
Basic Setup  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Time & Date  
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY  
12H  
Time  
&
Date  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
.
.
:
1
JAN  
03  
12 00 00  
AM  
SET  
OFF  
12 :00 AM  
AUTO  
OFF: Does not function.  
ON: Applies summer time.  
AUTO: Applies summer time in accordance with the setting  
of summer time (see next page).  
Auto Adjust Time  
Master Time  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)  
I
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
I
I
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table  
SETUP  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
8Summer Time (Day Light Saving) Table  
8Date Format  
Do the following to specify the start time and date and the  
end time and date of summer time.  
Select a display format for the date from the following. (Ex.  
April 1, 2003)  
YY.MM.DD: 03.4.1  
MMM.DD.YY: APR.1.03  
DD.MMM.YY: 1.APR.03  
[Screenshot 1]  
Start operation from the "Time & Date" menu.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
8Time Format  
Basic Setup  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Time & Date  
I
I
I
DD.MMM.YY  
12H  
Time  
&
Date  
Select a display format for the time from the following. (Ex.  
3 oclock in the afternoon)  
12h: 3:00:00 PM  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
.
.
:
1
JAN  
03  
12 00 00  
AM  
SET  
OFF  
12 :00 AM  
Auto Adjust Time  
Master Time  
I
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
AUTO  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)Table  
I
I
SETUP  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
24h: 15:00:00  
122  
z Move the cursor to "Summer Time (Day Light Saving)  
Table" using the arrows button (C D) and press the  
SET button.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
Basic Setup  
LIVE  
User Name  
I
I
Time  
&
Date  
User Password  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
LV1  
1
CAM1  
Level  
Priority  
Default Screen  
Camera Partitioning  
I
I
I
I
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
[Screenshot 2]  
The "Summer Time (Day Light Saving) Table" will be dis-  
played.  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
View/Operate  
CAM9  
View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM10 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM11 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM12 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM13 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM14 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM15 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM16 View/Operate  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
SET  
Y
1
ON  
SETUP MEN
24  
--  
--  
--  
24  
--  
D
D
JUN  
--  
M
M
M
M
M
M
03  
--  
--  
01  
--  
--  
H
00  
M
LIVE  
OFF  
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
--  
--  
--  
M
M
M
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
D
D
--  
--  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
2
--  
--  
Basic Setup  
D
JUN  
--  
--  
--  
JUN  
03  
--  
01  
--  
00  
M
M
M
3
D
--  
8User Name  
Time  
&
Date  
--  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
--  
--  
D
D
D
M
--  
--  
--  
--  
4
User Regist.  
User Edit  
M
M
M
M
--  
M
24  
--  
03  
--  
01  
--  
--  
--  
01  
--  
--  
--  
01  
--  
--  
00  
M
M
M
M
5
OFF  
D
--  
--  
Enter 4-14 alphanumeric characters for the user name.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete char-  
acters as for attaching text information to images. Refer to  
page 54.  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
--  
--  
ON -- --  
D
--  
--  
6
7
OFF  
--  
24  
--  
--  
--  
24  
--  
--  
D
--  
JUN  
--  
--  
--  
JUN  
--  
--  
--  
M
Y
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
03  
--  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
00  
--  
--  
--  
00  
--  
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
--  
--  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
8
9
03  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
10  
--  
--  
OK  
CANCEL  
8Password  
x Move the cursor to enter the ON or OFF time (year,  
Enter 4-8 alphanumeric characters for the password.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete char-  
acters as for attaching text information to images. Refer to  
page 54.  
month, date) for summer time using the arrows button.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The cursor will move to the selected cell for entry of the ON  
or OFF time for summer time.  
Important:  
Set a unique password, not something that would be  
easily guessed by a third person. The password also  
should be memorable.  
Y
1
ON  
SETUP MEN
24  
--  
--  
--  
24  
--  
D
D
JUN  
--  
M
M
M
M
M
M
03  
--  
--  
01  
--  
--  
H
00  
M
LIVE  
OFF  
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
--  
--  
--  
M
M
M
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
D
D
--  
--  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
2
--  
--  
Basic Setup  
D
JUN  
--  
--  
--  
JUN  
03  
--  
01  
--  
00  
M
M
M
3
D
--  
Time  
&
Date  
--  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
--  
--  
D
D
D
M
--  
--  
--  
--  
4
User Regist.  
User Edit  
M
M
M
M
--  
M
24  
--  
03  
--  
01  
--  
--  
--  
01  
--  
--  
--  
01  
--  
--  
00  
M
M
M
M
5
OFF  
D
--  
--  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
8Level  
--  
--  
ON -- --  
D
--  
--  
6
7
OFF  
--  
24  
--  
--  
--  
24  
--  
--  
D
--  
JUN  
--  
--  
--  
JUN  
--  
--  
--  
M
Y
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
ON  
OFF  
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
03  
--  
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
Y
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
00  
--  
--  
--  
00  
--  
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
M
Select a user level from the following.  
Setting of operable functions in each level is described in  
"User Level" (Refer to page 125).  
LV1/LV2/LV3  
--  
--  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
8
9
03  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
10  
--  
--  
OK  
CANCEL  
c Rotate the jog dial to enter the ON or OFF time (year,  
8Priority  
month, date) for summer time.  
Assign priority (1 (lowest) to 16 (highest)) to users.  
v Move the cursor to "OK" and press the SET button.  
The ON and OFF time for summer time will be  
applied and the "Summer Time (Day Light Saving)  
Table" will be closed.  
8Default Screen  
Select a camera image to be displayed during the login  
procedure from the following.  
CAM1 - 16: Displays an image from the selected camera  
channel.  
QUAD1 - 4: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 4  
on a 4-split screen.  
QUAD5 - 8: Displays images from camera channels 5 - 8  
on a 4-split screen.  
Note: When you move the cursor to "CANCEL" in step 4  
and press the SET button, the setting will be can-  
celed and the "Summer Time (Day Light Saving)  
Table" will be closed.  
QUAD9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from  
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split  
screen.  
QUAD9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split screen.  
QUAD13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split screen.  
7SCREEN: Displays images from camera channels 1 - 7 on  
a 7-split screen.  
[User Regist.] Registration of a user who  
operates this unit  
Register user information such as the user name and pass-  
word.  
After filling out the user information, move the cursor to  
"SET" at the lower right of the menu and press the SET but-  
ton to complete registration.  
9SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image  
from camera channel 1 - 9 on the upper left area on a  
9-split screen.  
123  
9SCREEN1 - 9 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 9 on a 9-split screen.  
9SCREEN10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays  
images from camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split  
screen.  
10SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 10 on a 10-split screen.  
13SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 13 on a 13-split screen.  
16SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 16 on a 16-split screen.  
SEQ: Images will be displayed in the sequential display.  
[Host Regist.] Registration of PC (host)  
accessible to this unit  
Register host information for the PC that accesses the unit  
via a network such as a LAN.  
Move the cursor to "SET" at the lower right on the menu and  
press the SET button to complete registration.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Host IP Address  
Level  
Priority  
Default Screen  
Camera Partitioning  
I
I
I
I
I
000  
LV1  
1
.
000  
.
000  
.
000  
Basic Setup  
Time  
&
Date  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
CAM1  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
View/Operate  
CAM9  
View/Operate  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
View/Operate CAM10 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM11 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM12 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM13 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM14 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM15 View/Operate  
View/Operate CAM16 View/Operate  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
8Camera Partitioning  
SET  
Select a controllable range for each camera channel from  
the following.  
View/Operate: Displaying live images and operating the  
camera are possible.  
View: Displaying live images is possible but cameras can-  
not be operated.  
--: Both displaying live images and operating the camera  
are impossible.  
8Host IP Address  
Enter the IP address. Move the cursor to "Host IP Address"  
and rotate the jog dial to enter the IP address. For this unit,  
enter 4 units from the decimal numbers (0-254).  
Notes:  
Entering "*" validates all numbers.  
It is impossible to register "0.0.0.0" or "*.*.*.*".  
[User Edit] Correction of the registered user  
information  
8Level  
It is possible to edit the registered user information.  
Move the cursor to "User Name" and rotate the jog dial to  
select the user name.  
The registered information will be displayed.  
Editing can be performed in the same way as registration.  
(Refer to page 123.)  
Select a user level from the following.  
Setting of operable functions for each level is described in  
"User Level" (Refer to page 125).  
LV1/LV2/LV3  
8Priority  
Move the cursor to "EDIT" at the lower right on the menu  
and press the SET button to complete editing.  
Assign priority (1 (lowest) to 16 (highest)) to hosts.  
8Default Screen  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Select a startup display to be displayed after login from the  
following.  
CAM1 - 16 (for the WJ-HD316)/CAM 1-9 (for the WJ-HD  
309): Displays live images from the selected camera  
channel on a single screen.  
User Name  
I
I
Basic Setup  
Time  
&
Date  
User Password  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
LV1  
16  
16 SCREEN  
Level  
Priority  
Default Screen  
Camera Partitioning  
I
I
I
I
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
View/Operate  
CAM9  
View  
View  
View  
--  
--  
--  
View/Operate CAM10  
View/Operate CAM11  
View/Operate CAM12  
View/Operate CAM13  
View/Operate CAM14  
View/Operate CAM15  
View/Operate CAM16  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
QUAD1 - 4: Displays live images from camera channels 1 -  
4 on a 4-split screen.  
--  
--  
EDIT  
QUAD5 - 8: Displays live images from camera channels 5 -  
8 on a 4-split screen.  
QUAD9 (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image from  
camera channel 9 on the upper left area on a 4-split  
screen.  
QUAD9 - 12 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays live  
images from camera channels 9 - 12 on a 4-split  
screen.  
QUAD13 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays live  
images from camera channels 13 - 16 on a 4-split  
screen.  
9SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD309): Displays an image  
from camera channel 1 - 9 on the upper left area on a  
9-split screen.  
[User Delete] Deletion of a registered user  
It is possible to delete a registered user.  
Move the cursor to "User Name" and rotate the jog dial to  
select the user name. Move the cursor to "DELETE" and  
press the SET button.  
The selected user will be deleted.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
User Name  
Basic Setup  
I
Time  
&
Date  
DELETE  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
9SCREEN1 - 9 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 9 on a 9-split screen.  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
124  
9SCREEN10 - 16 (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays  
images from camera channels 10 - 16 on a 9-split  
screen.  
16SCREEN (only for the WJ-HD316): Displays images  
from camera channels 1 - 16 on a 16-split screen.  
SEQ: Images will be displayed in the sequential display.  
[User Level] Setting of the operation level  
Set operable functions at each user level (LV 1/LV 2/  
LV 3).  
Rotate the jog dial to display "b" to enable operation.  
Leave it blank to disable operation.  
Refer to the table on the next page for each function.  
The default settings are shown as below.  
8Camera Partitioning  
Select a controllable range for each camera channel from  
the following.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
SChedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Basic Setup  
LV1 LV2 LV3  
View/Operate: Displaying live images and operating the  
camera are possible.  
View: Displaying live images is possible but cameras can-  
not be operated.  
--: Both displaying live images and operating camera are  
impossible.  
Time  
&
Date  
WJ-HD300 Setup  
WJ-HD300 Setup Status  
Camera Setup  
Event Log Status  
Access Log Status  
Error Log Status  
Alarm Reset  
Alarm Suspended Time  
Copy  
Normal Recording Erase  
Event Recording Erase  
Manual REC Operation  
Playback Operation  
N/W Access  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
Each parameter of the user level is as follows:  
LV1: Possible to perform all the operations (Administrators)  
LV2: Possible to refer the settings of the unit and the  
access log, and to perform the alarm reset (Head of  
operators)  
[Host Edit] Correction of the registered host  
information  
It is possible to edit the registered host information.  
Move the cursor to "Host IP Address" and rotate the jog dial  
to select the host IP address.  
LV3: Possible to monitor or play the images (Operators)  
The registered information will be displayed.  
Editing can be performed in the same way as registration.  
(Refer to page 124.)  
Move the cursor to "EDIT" at the lower right on the menu  
and press the SET button to complete editing.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Host IP Address  
Level  
Priority  
Default Screen  
Camera Partitioning  
I
I
I
I
I
000  
LV1  
16  
.
000  
.
000  
.
000  
Basic Setup  
Time  
&
Date  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
16 SCREEN  
CAM1  
CAM2  
CAM3  
CAM4  
CAM5  
CAM6  
CAM7  
CAM8  
View/Operate  
CAM9  
View  
View  
View  
--  
--  
--  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
View/Operate CAM10  
View/Operate CAM11  
View/Operate CAM12  
View/Operate CAM13  
View/Operate CAM14  
View/Operate CAM15  
View/Operate CAM16  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
--  
--  
EDIT  
[Host Delete] Deletion of a registered host  
It is possible to delete a registered host.  
Move the cursor to "Host Delete" and rotate the jog dial to  
select the host. Move the cursor to "DELETE" and press the  
SET button.  
The selected host will be deleted.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
Basic Setup  
LIVE  
Host IP Address  
I
0. 0. 0. 0  
DELETE  
Time  
&
Date Setup  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
125  
Functions that can be enabled/disabled  
The following functions can be enabled/disabled according to the user level.  
Function  
Description  
WJ-HD300 Setup  
WJ-HD300 Setup Status  
Camera Setup  
The SETUP MENU is displayed and the settings can be performed.  
Only the SETUP MENU can be displayed. The settings cannot be performed.  
The setting menu of the camera is displayed and the settings can be performed.  
The SETUP MENU is displayed and you can refer to the event log. (Refer to page  
96.) You also can refer to the network log. Refer to the Network Operating  
Instructions (PDF) for further information.  
Event Log Status  
Error Log Status  
The SETUP MENU is displayed and you can refer to the error log. (Refer to page 96.)  
The SETUP MENU is displayed and you can refer to the access log. (Refer to page  
97.)  
Access Log Status  
Alarm Reset  
An event operation can be canceled. (Refer to page 47.)  
An event operation can be suppressed. (Refer to page 47.)  
A recorded image can be manually copied. (Refer to page 48.)  
Image data in the normal recording area of the hard disk can be manually deleted.  
Image data in the event recording area of the hard disk can be manually deleted.  
Manual recording can be started and stopped.  
Alarm Suspend  
Copy  
Normal Recording Erase  
Event Recording Erase  
Manual REC Operation  
Playback Operation  
N/W Access  
A recorded image can be played.  
This unit can be logged into from a PC via a network.  
[Save/Load] Saving and loading of settings  
of the SETUP MENU  
It is possible to save the settings of the SETUP MENU in  
this unit.  
It is also possible to call up saved settings. (Load)  
Move the cursor to "SAVE" or "LOAD" and press the SET  
button.  
Maintenance  
Switcher  
Recording  
Display  
Event  
Comm  
Schedule  
System  
SETUP MENU  
LIVE  
Basic Setup  
User Setup Save  
User Setup Load  
I
I
SAVE  
LOAD  
Time  
&
Date  
User Regist.  
User Edit  
User Delete  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
Host Delete  
User Level  
Save/Load  
126  
DISPLAY SETUP MENU OF CAMERA  
For operating the camera connected to this unit, it is necessary to set the camera functions in advance.  
Setup of the camera functions can be performed on the setup menu of the connected camera.  
You can operate the camera setup menu by calling up it from this unit. Contents of the camera setting menu and operations  
vary according to the connected cameras. For further information, refer to the operating instructions of the camera.  
The following are the descriptions of how to display the camera setting menu.  
z Press the camera selection button for a desired camera channel and the SET button simultaneously.  
The camera setup menu will be displayed.  
Use the following buttons on the front panel to perform the settings of the camera setup menu.  
To move the cursor  
Arrows button (CD)  
To change the selected parameter  
Arrows button (AB)  
To determine the selected parameter  
To display the submenu  
SET button  
To return to the previous menu  
SETUP/ESC button  
x Press any one of the PAN/TILT button, the ZOOM/FOCUS button, the IRIS button, the PRESET/AUTO button and the cam-  
era selection buttons 4 - 16 for the WJ-HD316 (4 - 9 for the WJ-HD309) to complete the camera setting.  
Note: To display the special menu of the camera setup menu, press the camera selection button 2 after moving the cursor  
to SPECIAL on the camera setup menu.  
To reset the settings of the camera setup menu to the default settings, press the camera selection button 3 after mov-  
ing the cursor to CAMERA RESET on the special menu.  
Depending on the models of the connected cameras, the operation method and menu items are different. Refer to the  
operating instructions of the connected camera.  
127  
DISK MANAGEMENT  
I Notes on the hard disk  
Camera images are recorded into the built-in hard disk of  
I How to replace the built-in hard  
disk  
this unit.  
It is possible to replace the hard disk drive regardless of  
whether the power of the unit is on/off.  
However, the procedures for replacement are different.  
Refer to the operating instructions for the optional extension  
unit when replacing the hard disk in the extension unit.  
There are two hard disks in this unit. In case one of them  
malfunctions during recording, it is possible to keep record-  
ing with the other hard disk (mirror function).  
The internal hard disk of this unit is virtually divided into 3  
areas to manage the hard disk.  
Normal recording area: An area into which images are  
recorded at times other than an event occurrence such  
as manual recording.  
Event recording area: An area into which images are  
recorded at an event occurrence.  
When replacing the hard disk drive after turn-  
ing off the power of the unit.  
z Turn off the power of the unit and detach the power  
plug from the outlet.  
Copy area: An area into which copy data is stored.  
x Do the following to replace the hard disk drive.  
It is possible to check the available disk space for each  
area on "Disk Info" of "Maintenance" on the SETUP MENU.  
(Refer to page 94.)  
When connecting an optional extension unit (WJ-  
HDE300 series), it is possible to create a pre-recording  
area to perform pre-event recording (page 135) for up  
to 60 minutes.  
1. Open the connectors cover on the front panel and  
remove the fixing screws.  
Detach the front panel by sliding it after removing the  
screws.  
Operations for the hard disk drive such as initialization (for-  
matting) of the hard disk drive in the unit or the optional  
extension unit, or mirroring, etc., can be performed in the  
"HDD DISK MENU". (Refer to page 131.)  
Note: It is necessary to create either the normal recording  
area or the event record area. If the normal recording  
area is not created, manual recording images and  
schedule recording images are recorded into the event  
recording area. If the event recording area is not creat-  
ed, event recording images and emergency recording  
images are recorded into the normal recording area.  
Screw  
Connectors cover  
Important:  
Do not detach the cable connecting the unit and the  
front panel while the HDD status indicators are still lit or  
until 30 seconds have passed since the HDD status  
indicators went off.  
Protect the hard disk drives from static electricity.  
Do not stack them, or keep them upright.  
Do not use an electric screwdriver to fix them.  
(Tightening torque: Approx. 0.49 N · m (5 kgf · cm))  
Avoid rapid changes in the temperature/humidity to  
prevent condensation. (Acceptable change: within  
15°C/h (59 °F/h))  
128  
2. Remove the cable from the front panel.  
5. Detach the flat cable and the power supply cable from  
the hard disk drive. Detach the flat cable only from the  
hard disk drive. (Do not detach the flat cable from the  
circuit board.)  
When pulling the flat cable to detach from the hard disk  
drive, hold the pull-ring on the connector, not cable.  
Otherwise, it may cause breaking of wire.  
After detaching the cables, remove the screw on point  
A.  
Front panel  
connector  
Then, remove the four screws fixing the lower hard disk  
drive.  
When removing, hold the hard disk drive securely to  
prevent it from falling.  
After removing the four screws, detach the hard disk  
drive from the hard disk drive mounting angle.  
3. Remove the screws fixing the mounting unit, and then  
pull the hard disk drive mounting angle toward you.  
Screw removed from  
point A  
Hold these  
tabs and pull  
Connector of the  
power supply cable  
Screw removed from point A  
D
S
S
D
S
S
Screws  
SSD  
Only the upper and lower holes on both sides will be  
used when fixing by screws even though there are 3  
holes each on both sides.  
Screws for the lower hard disk drive  
(4 screws: 2 screws each  
on the both sides)  
4. Remove the four screws fixing the upper hard disk  
drive.  
Hard disk drive mounting angle  
When removing, hold the hard disk drive securely to  
prevent it from falling.  
Then, detach the flat cable from the hard disk drive and  
detach the hard disk drive from the hard disk mounting  
angle.  
6. Install the new hard disk drive in the reverse order used  
for detaching the hard disk drive.  
Confirm that the hard disk drive is set as master using  
the jumper connector.  
Jumper pin  
Important:  
Power supply  
Pull-ring  
cable  
When installing, confirm that there is no dust around the  
connectors. Adhesion of dust may cause malfunction.  
The jumper connector setting differs depending on the  
models or the manufacturers. Refer to the indication  
label or the operating instructions of the used hard disk  
drive.  
Flat cable  
Connector  
SSD  
Attach the connector and the screws firmly. Otherwise,  
it may cause problems.  
c After replacing the hard disk drive, insert the power  
plug into the outlet and turn on the power of the unit.  
The "HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed automati-  
cally after the restart.  
Screws for the upper  
hard disk drive  
(4 screws: 2 screws each  
on the both sides)  
Hard disk drive mounting angle  
129  
When replacing the hard disk drive without  
turning off the power of the unit.  
When replacing the built-in hard disk of the  
extension unit  
With displaying the HDD SAFETY MODE window, start  
replacing the built-in hard disk of the optional extension  
unit.  
Refer to the operating instructions of the optional extension  
unit for the descriptions of how to replace the hard disk.  
z Close the SETUP MENU after selecting "ON" for "HDD  
Safety Mode" of "Disk Info" on the "Maintenance" menu.  
The HDD SAFETY MODE window will be displayed.  
c After completing the replacement of the hard disk,  
move the cursor to "OFF" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
The unit will restart and the HDD DISK MENU will be  
displayed automatically.  
v Perform the settings for the disk according to your  
x The procedures are different between the replacement  
of the hard disk of the unit and the replacement of the  
hard disk of the optional extension unit.  
needs. Refer to page 133 for further information.  
When replacing the built-in hard disk of the unit  
Move the cursor to "REMOVE" using the arrows button and  
press the SET button.  
The "REMOVE" indication will change to "REMOVING".  
The power supply to the front panel will be cut and the unit  
cannot be operated with the front panel.  
Detach the cable from the front panel and start replacing  
the built-in hard disk.  
Start from step 2 on page 128 to replace the built-in hard  
disk.  
Important:  
Detach the cable from the front panel after confirming  
that "REMOVING" is displayed. Otherwise, it may cause  
malfunction.  
The "REMOVING" indication will return to "REMOVE" by  
attaching the cable to the front panel. The power will be  
supplied to the front panel and the unit can be operated  
with the front panel.  
130  
I About the HDD DISK MENU  
The operations regarding the hard disk can be performed by displaying the "HDD DISK MENU" on monitor 2.  
The "HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed when the SET button is pressed while displaying the system check complete window.  
The "HDD DISK MENU" will also be displayed automatically after replacing or removing the hard disk.  
The following operations can be performed on the "HDD DISK MENU".  
Setting item  
FORMAT  
Description  
Page  
133  
Formats (initializes) the hard disk. It can also change the setting values for  
the recording area respectively. Mirroring can also be started on this menu.  
MIRROR ON  
MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
Recovers the mirrored hard disk.  
Cancels mirroring.  
138  
138  
139  
Removes the hard disk drive from the system logically.  
Restarts this unit.  
Closes the "HDD DISK MENU".  
I Display of the HDD DISK MENU  
Information of the hard disk drive of the unit or the optional extension unit will be displayed on the "HDD DISK MENU".  
Main unit/optional extension unit  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
Information about hard disk located in the main unit and optional exten-  
sion unit  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
160 GB: Indicates the hard disk capacity (disk existed  
when last started up)  
ERROR: Indicates that the hard disk has failed to be initial-  
ized.  
160 GB M: Indicates the hard disk capacity (mirrored disk  
existed when last started up)  
Important:  
ADD (160 GB): Indicates that this hard disk is newly mount-  
ed at this startup, but that it was not mounted last time.  
Those parenthesized numbers indicate the capacity of  
the hard disk.  
It is impossible to operate the unit when there is a hard  
disk with indications of * (capacity), * (ERROR), LOST  
or ERROR. In this case, remove the relevant hard disk.  
(Refer to page 139.)  
ADD (ERROR): Indicates that this hard disk is newly  
mounted at this startup, but that it was not mounted last  
time. Then, an error is detected on the hard disk.  
* (160 GB): Indicates that a different hard disk from the one  
that existed at the last startup is mounted. Those paren-  
thesized numbers indicate the capacity of the hard  
disk.  
* (ERROR): Indicates that a different hard disk from the one  
that existed at the last startup is mounted, and an error  
has been detected on the hard disk.  
Hard disks with ADD (capacity) indication are not initial-  
ized yet.  
First, initialize them. It is impossible to record images on  
it or to use it as a copy destination without initialization.  
Note: The displayed available disk space on this menu will  
not include the space required for data management.  
Therefore, the understated available disk space will be  
displayed.  
It is possible to display information about the recording  
area (allocated disk size for normal recording area,  
event recording area and copy area) by pressing the  
SETUP/ESC button while displaying the "TOP MENU" of  
the "HDD DISK MENU".  
LOST: Indicates that a position where a hard disk was  
mounted at the last startup has no hard disk.  
: Indicates that a hard disk is not mounted this time nor  
was it at the last startup.  
131  
I RAID 5 Function of the Extension Unit  
Summary of the RAID 5 function (Redundant  
Arrays for Independent Disks, independent  
data disks with distributed parity blocks)  
Setup/cancel the RAID 5 function  
Do the following to set or cancel the RAID 5 function with an  
optional extension unit.  
Refer to the operating instructions of the extension unit for  
further information.  
It is possible to use the RAID 5 function with an optional  
extension unit.  
RAID level 5 regards 3 or more drives as one drive, and it is  
possible to read data by attaching error correction data  
even though one of the drives is broken automatically. (It is  
impossible to recover data if two drives are simultaneously  
damaged or the second drive fails during the data recovery  
process.)  
RAID level 5 requires a minimum of 3 drives to implement.  
When using the RAID function, the logical disk size of the  
extension unit will be as below.  
z Make sure that the power of this unit and all of the  
extension units to be connected is OFF.  
x To set the RAID 5 function, set the mode switch of the  
extension unit to "RAID 5".  
To cancel the RAID 5 function, set the mode switch of  
the extension unit to "SINGLE".  
c Make sure that the HDD POWER switch of the extension  
Logical disk size = Smallest size of the disk among the  
disks in the extension unit x (Number of the disks in the  
extension unit - 1)  
unit is "ON".  
v Turn the power of the extension unit on.  
Note: Depending on the model of a hard disk drive, the  
logical disk size may be a few percent smaller than the  
size resulting from the formula above.  
b Turn the power of this unit on.  
The "HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed automati-  
cally after the system check when the hard disk  
configuration has been changed such as when an  
extension unit is newly connected.  
Important:  
When connecting two extension units or more with this  
unit, it is impossible to connect the extension unit with  
the RAID 5 function and the one without the RAID 5  
function at the same time.  
When the RAID 5 function is used, it is impossible to  
use two hard disks in this unit. The recorded pictures in  
those disks will not be deleted.  
Important:  
When the RAID 5 function is set or canceled, all data on  
each hard disk of the extension unit will be deleted.  
When turning the power on, turn on the power of the  
extension unit first, and then turn the power of this unit  
on. Otherwise, the extension unit may not work correct-  
ly.  
132  
v Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the  
jog dial.  
I Formatting (Initialization) the  
Hard Disk  
It is necessary to initialize the hard disk in the following  
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-  
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to  
enter numbers for password.  
cases.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete  
characters as for attaching text information to images.  
Refer to page 54.  
When replacing the hard disk of this unit  
When operating the unit for the first time after connect-  
ing the optional extension unit to this unit  
b Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button  
Important:  
(CD) and press the SET button.  
When the hard disk is formatted (initialized), all of the  
recorded images will be deleted.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The "THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT" menu will be dis-  
played.  
Formatting (initialization) all hard  
disks (unit)  
All hard disks including the built-in hard disks and the hard  
disks in the extension units will be initialized. All units will be  
initialized when the RAID 5 function is set.  
Digital Disk Recorder  
HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT  
ALL FORMAT SELECTED DISC MIRROR FORMAT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
*(ERROR)  
z Turn on the power of any peripheral devices such as an  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
extension unit connected to this unit.  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
x Turn on the power of this unit and press the SET button  
after completing the system check.  
n Move the cursor to "ALL UNITS" using the arrows button  
(AB) and press the SET button.  
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the  
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-  
matically displayed.  
Select "ALL UNITS" when using the RAID 5 function.  
Digital Disk Recorder  
HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT  
ALL UNIT ONE UNIT  
[Screenshot 1]  
MAIN  
-
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played.  
EXT1 480GB  
EXT2 480GB  
EXT3 480GB  
EXT4 *(480GB)  
EXT5 ADD (480GB)  
EXT6 480GB  
EXT7 LOST  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[Screenshot 4]  
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
The "RECORDING AREA SETUP OF ALL DISKS" will be dis-  
played.  
c Move the cursor to "FORMAT" using the arrows button  
(A B) and press the SET button.  
Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
DWigitaJl -HD300  
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT RECORDING AREA SETUP OF ALL DISK  
Normal area  
90GB  
Event area  
1800GB  
Copy area  
450GB  
Free area  
450GB  
[Screenshot 2]  
The password entry window will be displayed.  
HDD Total capacity : 2790GB  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
Enter the password.  
160GB  
-
m Select a recording area using the arrows button (A B)  
and rotate the jog dial to set the capacity for the select-  
ed recording area.  
EXECUTE CANCEL  
EXT5 A
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Repeat this operation to set the capacity for the other  
recording areas.  
133  
[Screenshot 2]  
, Press the SET button after setting.  
The password entry window will be displayed.  
[Screenshot 5]  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
Disk Recorder  
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
DWigitaJl -HD300  
HDD DISK MENU  
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT RECORDING AREA SETUP OF ALL DISK  
Enter the password.  
160GB  
-
Normal aea  
9
veaea  
y aea  
ee aea  
EXECUTE  
CANCEL  
Starting format of all HDDs,  
EXT5 A
and all of data in HDDs  
are going to be erased.  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
EXECUTE CANCEL  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
v Rotate the jog dial to enter the password for an admin-  
istrator.  
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-  
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to  
enter numbers for password.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete  
characters as for attaching text information to images.  
Refer to page 54.  
. Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button  
(A B) and press the SET button.  
Formatting will start and the format result dialog  
window will be displayed. The "TOP MENU" of the  
"HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed automatically  
after displaying the format result dialog window.  
b Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button (C D)  
and press the SET button.  
Formatting (initialization) the  
selected hard disk (unit)  
[Screenshot 3]  
The "THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT" menu will be dis-  
played.  
Do the following to format the selected hard disk (the  
selected unit when using the RAID 5 function).  
z Turn on the power of any peripheral devices such as an  
Digital Disk Recorder  
HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT  
extension unit connected to this unit.  
ALL FORMAT SELECTED DISC MIRROR FORMAT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
x Turn on the power of this unit.  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
An image saying that the system check has been com-  
pleted will be displayed.  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the  
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played automatically.  
Digital Disk Recorder  
HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT  
ALL UNIT  
ONE UNIT  
MAIN  
-
EXT1 480GB  
EXT2 480GB  
EXT3 480GB  
EXT4 *(480GB)  
EXT5 ADD (480GB)  
EXT6 480GB  
EXT7 LOST  
[Screenshot 1]  
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played.  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>  
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
n Move the cursor to "SELECTED DISK" using the arrows  
button (A B) and press the SET button.  
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
When using the RAID 5 function, select "ONE UNIT" on  
"THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT" menu.  
c Move the cursor to "FORMAT" using the arrows button  
(A B) and press the SET button.  
134  
[Screenshot 4]  
, Select a setting method for each recording area from  
the following using the arrows button (A B) and press  
the SET button.  
The "DISK SELECT" menu will be displayed.  
When using the RAID 5 function, the "UNIT SELECTION"  
menu will be displayed.  
Auto Setup: Assigns the same proportion for each  
recording area as the proportion of the existing  
hard disks. (step 9)  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT DISK SELECT  
All Copy Area: Sets the whole selected hard disk (unit)  
Select HDD to be formatted,and press [SET]key.  
1
160GB M  
160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
2
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
3
4
as the copy area. (step 9)  
MAIN  
EXT1  
160GB  
160GB  
All Pre REC Area: Sets the whole selected hard disk  
(extension unit) as the pre-recording area. (step  
10)  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
Detailed Setup: Sets each recording area individually.  
(step 11)  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Important:  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT UNIT SELECTION  
When the built-in hard disk of this unit is selected, "All  
Pre REC Area" is not available.  
Select HDD to be formatted,and press [SET] key.  
MAIN  
EXT1  
-
480GB  
EXT2 480GB  
EXT3 480GB  
EXT4 *(480GB)  
EXT5 ADD (480GB)  
EXT6 480GB  
EXT7 LOST  
[Screenshot 6]  
The confirmation menu of the set recording area will be dis-  
played.  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
DISK SETTING METHOD  
AUTO SETUP  
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>  
Normal area  
10GB  
Event area  
80GB  
Copy area  
35GB  
Free area  
35GB  
m Move the cursor to a desired hard disk (unit) to be for-  
matted (initialized) using the arrows button and press  
the SET button.  
HDD Total capacity:160GB  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
[Screenshot 5]  
"THE SETTING METHOD" menu will be displayed.  
<Screen displayed when selecting "AUTO SETUP">  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
DISK SELECT  
THE SETTING METHOD  
Auto Setup All Copy Area All Pre REC Area Detailed Setup  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
DISK SETTING METHOD  
ALL COPY AREA  
1
160GB M  
160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
2
3
4
MAIN  
EXT1  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
Normal area  
0GB  
Event area  
0GB  
Copy area  
160GB  
Free area  
0GB  
160GB  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
HDD Total capacity:160GB  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
DISK SELECT THE SETTING METHOD  
WJ-HD300  
<Screen displayed when selecting "ALL COPY AREA">  
Auto Setup All Copy Area All Pre REC Area Detailed Setup  
MAIN  
-
EXT1  
480GB  
. Confirm the capacity of the set recording area and  
press the SET button.  
EXT2 480GB  
EXT3 480GB  
EXT4 *(480GB)  
EXT5 ADD (480GB)  
EXT6 480GB  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
(step 13)  
EXT7 LOST  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
<Screen displayed when using the RAID 5 function>  
135  
[Screenshot 7]  
[Screenshot 9]  
The "PRE RECORDING AREAS" menu will be displayed.  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
DISK SETTING METHOD  
PRE RECORDING AREAS  
WJ-HD300  
DISK SETTING METHOD  
DETAILED SETUP  
1CH  
0GB  
2CH  
0GB  
3CH  
0GB  
4CH  
0GB  
5CH  
0GB  
6CH  
0GB  
7CH  
0GB  
8CH  
0GB  
Normal aea  
1
Event aea  
Coy aea Fee aea  
Starting one (1) disk formatting.  
All of contents in the disk is erased.  
9CH  
0GB  
10CH  
0GB  
11CH  
0GB  
12CH  
0GB  
13CH  
0GB  
14CH  
0GB  
15CH  
0GB  
16CH  
0GB  
FREE  
0GB  
EXECUTE  
CANCEL  
HDD Total capacity:160GB  
[
]
[
]
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Select the camera channel for pre-event recording  
using the arrows button and assign the disk space to  
the selected pre-recording area by rotating the jog dial.  
Repeat this operation to assign disk space to two or  
more camera channels.  
Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button  
(A B) and press the SET button.  
Formatting will start and the "TOP MENU" of the  
"HDD DISK MENU" will be displayed.  
Press the SET button after setting.  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
(step 13)  
Important:  
It is impossible to select the camera channel to which  
the pre-recording area on another hard disk (extension  
unit) is already assigned.  
[Screenshot 8]  
The "DETAILED SETUP" menu will be displayed.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
DISK SETTING METHOD  
DETAILED SETUP  
Normal area  
110GB  
Event area  
0GB  
Copy area  
0GB  
Free area  
50GB  
HDD Total capacity:160GB  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Select the recording area using the arrows button and  
assign the disk space to the selected recording area by  
rotating the jog dial.  
Repeat this operation to assign disk space to two or  
more recording areas.  
Press the SET button after setting.  
Press the SET button after setting.  
136  
I Setting for Mirroring  
Mirroring is the function that records camera images onto  
two hard disks simultaneously. In case one hard disk has a  
problem, image data will be stored on the other hard disk.  
The credibility of the disk can be enhanced.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The password entry window will be displayed.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
It is recommended to activate the mirroring function for the  
first use of this unit.  
When the mirroring function is activated with remaining  
recorded images in the hard disk, those recorded images  
in the hard disk will be deleted.  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
4
MAIN
EXT1
EXT2
EXT3
EXT4 *
Enter the password.  
160GB  
-
EXECUTE CANCEL  
EXT5
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Important:  
The mirroring function can be configured only by two of  
the built-in hard disks.  
The size of the two hard disks used for the mirroring  
function must be the same.  
When using the RAID 5 function, it is impossible to acti-  
vate the mirroring function.  
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the  
jog dial.  
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-  
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to  
enter numbers for the password.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete  
characters as for attaching text information to images.  
Refer to page 54.  
Start mirroring  
Do the following to activate the mirroring function.  
v Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button  
(CD) and press the SET button.  
z Turn on the power of this unit.  
An image saying that the system check has been com-  
pleted will be displayed.  
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
Digital Disk Recorder  
HDD DISK MENU  
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the  
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-  
matically displayed.  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU THE CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT  
ALL FORMAT SELECTED DISC MIRROR FORMAT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
*(ERROR)  
[Screenshot 1]  
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played.  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
b Move the cursor to "MIRROR FORMAT" using the  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
arrows button (CD) and press the SET button.  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
[Screenshot 4]  
The "MIRROR AREA SETUP" menu will be displayed.  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
DISK SETTING METHOD  
MIRROR AREA SETUP  
Normal area  
10GB  
Event area  
90GB  
Copy area  
30GB  
Free area  
30GB  
x Move the cursor to "FORMAT" using the arrows button  
(A B) and press the SET button.  
HDD Total capacity:160GB  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
137  
[Screenshot 2]  
The password entry window will be displayed.  
n Select a recording area using the arrows button and  
assign the disk space to the selected recording area by  
rotating the jog dial.  
Repeat this operation to assign disk space to two or  
more recording areas.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
Enter the password.  
160GB  
-
m Press the SET button after setting.  
EXECUTE CANCEL  
EXT5 A
[Screenshot 5]  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
, Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button  
(A B) and press the SET button.  
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the  
jog dial.  
Mirroring will start and the "TOP MENU" of the "HDD  
DISK MENU" will be displayed.  
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-  
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to  
enter numbers for password.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300  
DISK CANDIDATE FOR A FORMAT  
MIRROR AREA SETUP  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete  
characters as for attaching text information to images.  
Refer to page 54.  
No
Starting mirror format of HDDs  
in main unit, and all of data  
in HDDs are going to be erased.  
EXECUTE  
CANCEL  
v Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button  
(CD) and press the SET button.  
[
]
[
]
RETURN: SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
[Screenshot 3]  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
Cancel mirroring (MIRROR OFF)  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
Do the following to cancel the mirroring function.  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
3
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
4
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *(
z Turn on the power of this unit.  
Mirror "OFF" in main unit.  
160GB  
160GB  
-
An image saying that the system check has been com-  
pleted will be displayed.  
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.  
OK  
CANCEL  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Close the information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the  
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-  
matically displayed.  
b Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button (A B)  
and press the SET button.  
Mirroring will be canceled.  
[Screenshot 1]  
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played.  
Note: One of the two hard disks involved in mirroring  
will be indicated as "* (capacity)" on the "TOP  
MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" after canceling the  
mirroring function.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
Hard disk recovery (MIRROR ON)  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
Do the following to recover the hard disk when one of the  
hard disks involved in mirroring is damaged while mirroring,  
or when one of the hard disks is replaced.  
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
By completing the following procedures, recovery of the  
hard disk will start when the unit is in operation after the  
HDD DISK MENU is closed.  
x Move the cursor to "MIRROR OFF" using the arrows but-  
ton (A B) and press the SET button.  
z Turn on the power of this unit.  
An image saying that the system check has been com-  
pleted will be displayed.  
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.  
138  
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the  
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-  
matically displayed.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
[Screenshot 1]  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played.  
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
M
i
rr  
o
r
"ON" in m
a
in  
u
nit.  
160GB  
160GB  
-
OK  
CANCEL  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
*(ERROR)  
b Move the cursor to "OK" using the arrows button (A B)  
and press the SET button.  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Recovery of the hard disk will start when the unit is  
in operation after the "HDD DISK MENU" is closed.  
x Move the cursor to "MIRROR ON" using the arrows but-  
ton (A B) and press the SET button.  
Remove the Hard Disk Logically and  
Reconfigure it (REMOVE)  
Note: When it is impossible to recover the hard disk  
(mirror on) such in case that the hard disk size to be  
recovered is too small, it is impossible to select  
"MIRROR ON".  
It is possible to remove the hard disk logically (unmount)  
without uninstalling (detaching) the hard disk physically. It  
is recommended to remove the hard disk logically when the  
hard disk of the unit or an extension unit is having trouble  
(hard disk indicated with "*", "LOST" or "ERROR") and it is  
necessary to remove it temporarily but not to stop opera-  
tion.  
[Screenshot 2]  
The password entry window will be displayed.  
Do the following to remove the hard disk logically.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
3
RESTART  
EXIT  
z Turn on the power of this unit.  
1
2
4
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
An image saying that the system check has been com-  
pleted will be displayed.  
Press the SET button after the image is displayed.  
Enter the password.  
160GB  
-
EXECUTE CANCEL  
EXT5 A
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
Note: When the hard disk is replaced or removed, the  
"TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be auto-  
matically displayed.  
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the  
jog dial.  
[Screenshot 1]  
The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played.  
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-  
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to  
enter numbers for password.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete  
characters as for attaching text information to images.  
Refer to page 54.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
1
2
3
4
MAIN 160GB M  
EXT1 160GB  
EXT2 160GB  
EXT3 160GB  
EXT4 *(160GB)  
160GB M  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
160GB  
-
160GB  
160GB  
v Move the cursor to "EXECUTE" using the arrows button  
*(ERROR)  
EXT5 ADD (160GB) ADD (ERROR) 160GB  
(CD) and press the SET button.  
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
x Move the cursor to "REMOVE" using the arrows button  
(A B) and press the SET button.  
139  
[Screenshot 2]  
The password entry window will be displayed.  
Digital Disk Recorder HDD DISK MENU  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU  
FORMAT  
MIRROR ON MIRROR OFF  
REMOVE  
RESTART  
EXIT  
MAIN 1
EXT1 1
EXT2 1
EXT3 1
EXT4 *
Enter the password.  
160GB  
-
EXECUTE CANCEL  
EXT5 A
EXT6 160GB  
EXT7 LOST  
160GB  
-
160GB  
-
[
]
[
]
Information of recording areas : SETUP/ESC OK : SET  
c Enter the password for an administrator by rotating the  
jog dial.  
The camera selection buttons ([1] - [10/0] for the WJ-  
HD316, [1] - [9], [0] for the WJ-HD309) are available to  
enter numbers for password.  
The same method is used to enter, insert and delete  
characters as for attaching text information to images.  
Refer to page 54.  
The hard disk will be removed logically and the  
confirmation dialog window will be displayed.  
[Screenshot 3]  
The confirmation dialog window will be displayed after logi-  
cal remove of the hard disk is started.  
Digital Disk Recorder  
WJ-HD300 TOP MENU REMOVING  
HDD DISK MENU  
REMOVING  
MAIN : REMOVED OK  
EXT1–4 : REMOVED OK  
EXT2–1 : REMOVED OK  
EXT2–2 : REMOVED OK  
EXT5–3 : REMOVED OK  
EXT6–1 : REMOVED OK  
EXT6–2 : REMOVED OK  
EXT6–3 : REMOVED OK  
EXT6–4 : REMOVED OK  
EXT7–1 : REMOVED OK  
v The "TOP MENU" of the "HDD DISK MENU" will be dis-  
played when logical remove has been completed.  
140  
SERIAL (RS232C) CONNECTOR COMMAND REFERENCE  
I SERIAL (RS232C) Communication Protocol  
With the SERIAL (RS232C) interface, you can control functions of this unit by transferring the specified commands from a per-  
sonal computer (PC) to this unit.  
Notes:  
This unit does not support the communication converted between the SERIAL (RS232C) and USB interface.  
When controlling the unit with the SERIAL (RS232C) interface, the following parameters should be identical between the  
communication devices.  
The setting is available in "SETUP MENU" "Comm" " SERIAL (RS232C) Setting".  
Baud Rate  
Data Bit  
Parity  
Stop Bit  
I Command Format  
The following pages detail how to write the commands.  
1. The following details how to write the commands  
Code  
ASCII  
[STX] AD [Unit address of this unit] [Transmission Command] : [p] [ETX]  
(02H) – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – (03H)  
STX: This shows the data start. STX (ASCII code: 02h) is always prefixed to data. h shows hexadecimal digit.  
Transmission command: A command shown in the Command List is designated.  
ETX: This shows the data end. ETX (ASCII code: 03h) is always prefixed to data.  
The character code is ASCII.  
When a command needs a parameter, a colon (:) is used for dividing the command and parameter. The following shows  
how to write the commands when two or more commands are specified.  
Code  
[STX] AD [Unit address of this unit] [Transmission Command] : [p1] : [p2] [ETX]  
2. Response Command (from the Unit to the PC)  
The unit sends back the response command for the transmission command from the PC.  
When the reception was completed successfully  
The response command differs between when an ANSWER command (sending back the status or data) is required or  
when not required.  
When no ANSWER command is required  
The unit sends back the same identifier as that in the transmission command, as shown in the figure.  
Transmission command (The unit)  
Response command (The unit)  
[STX]  
OPL  
[ETX]  
[STX]  
OPL  
[ETX]  
Same identifier  
141  
When an ANSWER command is required  
The unit sends back the status or data, as shown in the figure.  
Transmission command (The unit)  
Response command (The unit)  
[STX]  
QOP  
[ETX]  
[STX]  
OPL  
[ETX]  
Status inquiry command  
Status information command  
Transmission command (The unit)  
Response command (The unit)  
[STX]  
QRV  
[ETX]  
[STX]  
QRV:1.01:1.01:1.00:1.10 [ETX]  
Version inquiry command  
Sends back data.  
About ACK code  
After receiving a command from the PC, the unit sends back the ACK code to the PC in 20 ms or less.  
[ACK] = Reception succeeded (ASCII code: 06H)  
After the ACK code has been sent back and the command processing has been completed, the unit sends back the  
response command to the PC.  
Example:  
These are examples for the following operations.  
1. Login with the user name of "ADMIN" and with password of "12345".  
2. Display images from camera channel 1 on monitor 2.  
3. Start playback from the point of January 1 2003, 3:00 p.m.  
4. Logout  
(1) (This unit -> PC) Login  
[STX]AD001;OLI:ADMIN[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP]  
[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP]:12345[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP]  
[SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP] [SP][ETX]  
When receiving the command above, this unit will start the login procession of the user name of "ADMIN".  
(2) (This unit -> PC) Response against (1).  
[STX]AD001;OLI:1[ETX]  
(3) (PC -> This unit) Select the monitor 2  
[STX]AD001;OMS:001[ETX]  
(4) (This unit -> PC) Response against (3).  
[STX]AD001;OLI:1[ETX]  
(5) (PC -> This unit) Display images from the camera channel 1.  
[STX]AD001;OCS:00001[ETX]  
(6) (This unit - > PC) Response against (5).  
[STX]AD001;OCS:00002[ETX]  
(7) (PC -> This unit) Playback from the designated time point.  
[STX]AD001;ZTP:20030101150000[ETX]  
When receiving the command above, this unit will start playback from the point of January 1 2003, 3:00 p.m.  
(8) (This unit - > PC) Response against (7).  
[STX]AD001;ZTP: 200301011500000[ETX]  
142  
(9) (PC -> This unit) Logout.  
[STX]AD001;OLO [ETX]  
When receiving the command above, the user logged in via SERIAL (RS232C) (ADMIN) will log out.  
(10)(This unit - > PC) Response against (9).  
[STX]AD001;OLO[ETX]  
Note: The character code of [STX], [ETX] and [SP] are as follows.  
[STX]: 02h  
[ETX]: 03h  
[SP] (space): 20h  
3. Reception Error  
The response command differs between the reception error and parameter error.  
Communication error (Reception error)  
When the unit cannot properly receive the command due to the communication error, the unit immediately sends back the  
NACK code to the PC. After clearing the receive buffer, the unit enters the wait state until receiving the following [STX]  
command.  
[NCK] = Reception failed (ASCII code: 15H)  
N
Reason for the communication error  
1: Parity error (ASCII code: 31H)  
2: Framing error (ASCII code: 33H)  
3: Overrun error (ASCII code: 34H)  
Parameter error  
When the unit cannot properly process the received command, the unit sends back an error code to the PC. After clearing  
the receive buffer, the unit enters the wait state until receiving the following [STX] command.  
ER  
N
[ETX]  
=Error  
Reason for the error  
001: Command invalid (There is no associated command.)  
002: Parameter invalid (The number, digit, or range of the command  
parameters is incorrect.)  
003: Command invalid (The unit does not support the operation mode.)  
E: Command error (ASCII code: 45H)  
If the unit receives another command during the response, the unit will respond to the command after processing the cur-  
rent response.  
If the unit received the [STX] command again before receiving the [ETX] command, the unit will clear the internal buffer.  
Then, the unit will process the data following to the [STX] command. (The commands received before the second [STX]  
command will be canceled.)  
The internal buffer will be cleared when it fills up.*  
143  
4. PC Connection Example  
An RS232C crossing cable is used for connection between the unit and PC. (Refer to the following page for cable specifica-  
tion.)  
D-sub Pin 9  
(Female)  
D-sub Pin 9  
(Female)  
1
SIGNAL GND  
3
1
MODE  
COPY  
1
SERIAL  
ALARM  
2
1
CASCADE  
OUT  
4
2
POWER  
AC IN  
2
AUDIO IN  
AUDIO OUT  
15  
MONITOR OUT CASCADE IN  
MONITOR (VGA)  
ALARM/CONTOROL  
8
DATA  
RS485(CAMERA)  
4
10/100BASE-T EXT STORAGE  
16  
14  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
7
7
6
6
5
5
3
3
2
1
IN  
PC  
OUT  
16  
15  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
4
2
1
VIDEO  
This unit  
As viewed from the rear of the  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
5
1
Pin No. Signal Name  
I/O  
Cross cable connection example  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
CD  
TXD  
RXD  
DTR  
SG  
IN  
IN  
7 (RTS)  
8 (CTS)  
3 (TXD)  
5 (GND)  
2 (RXD)  
7 (RTS)  
8 (CTS)  
3 (TXD)  
5 (GND)  
2 (RXD)  
9
6
OUT  
OUT  
DSR  
RTS  
CTS  
RI  
IN  
WJ-HD316/WJ-HD309  
PC or another device  
OUT  
IN  
IN  
144  
Basic Operation  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Forward a field  
Rewind a field  
Pause during playback  
Play  
Manual recording  
Manual recording with  
text  
OVF  
OVR  
OPA  
OPL  
ORC  
OVF  
OVR  
OPA  
OPL  
ORC  
ZMR:nn  
...  
ZMR:nn:ddd ddd  
nn=01~99 (Sequence number)  
...  
ddd ddd: text (200 bytes or less)  
Stop  
OSP:n  
OSP  
OSF  
n=P: Stops PLAY  
n=R: Stops REC  
no parameter stops PLAY and REC  
n=0F Normal speed  
n=1F x2 speed  
Skip & play forward  
OSF:n  
n=2F x5 speed  
n=3F x10 speed  
n=4F x20 speed  
n=5F x50 speed  
n=6F x100 speed  
n=0S Normal speed  
n=1S 1/2 speed  
Skip&play reversely  
OSR:n  
OSR  
n=0F Normal speed  
n=1F x2 speed  
n=2F x5 speed  
n=3F x10 speed  
n=4F x20 speed  
n=5F x50 speed  
n=6F x100 speed  
n=0S Normal speed  
n=1S 1/2 speed  
Record No. Search and  
playback  
Time & date search and  
playback  
ZPR:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr:mm  
ZTP:yyyymmddhhnnss  
OSK:dnn  
ZPR:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr  
ZTP:yyyymmddhhnnss  
OSK  
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr Record No.  
yyyymmddhhnnss:Time & date of playback  
image  
d=+ Forward  
Record skip  
Backward  
nn=01 Number of skipped records: Fixed  
LISTED Playback  
ZLT:n  
ZPM  
ZLT:n  
n=0 OFF  
n=1 ON  
Playback latest image  
A - B repeat playback  
ZPM  
ZRP:n  
ZRP:n:yyyymmddhhnnss  
n=0 A - B repeat playback OFF  
n=1 Set repeat start point (A point)  
n=2 Set repeat end point (B point)  
yyyymmddhhnnss: Date and time of A/B point  
n=0 COPY SETUP MENU OFF  
n=1 COPY SETUP MENU ON  
n=0 Text display OFF  
n=1 Text display ON  
Display COPY SETUP  
MENU  
Display text  
ZPD:n  
ZDT:n  
OTC:m  
ZPD:n  
ZDT:n  
OTC:m  
Multi-screen switching  
m=0 4-split screen  
m=1 7-split screen  
m=2 9-split screen  
m=3 10-split screen  
m=4 13-split screen  
m=5 16-split screen  
nnnn=0001 Select MON 1  
nnnn=0002 Select MON 2  
Monitor selection  
Camera selection  
OMS:nnnn  
OCS:ccccc  
OMS:nnnn  
OCS:ccccc  
ccccc: Camera CH  
145  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Electronic zooming  
OZM:m  
OZM:n  
m=0 Electronic zooming OFF  
m=1 Electronic zooming ON  
m=> Switch x2 -> x4  
m=< Switch x4 -> x2  
m=+ Switch Electronic zooming OFF -> x2 ->  
x4 -> Electronic zooming OFF -> ...  
m=- Switch x4 -> x2 -> Electronic zooming OFF  
-> x4 -> ...  
n=0 Electronic zooming OFF  
n=2 x2  
n=4 x4 term  
Start sequence  
Stop sequence  
Disk selection  
OQT:01F  
OQS:0  
ZDS:k  
OQT:01F:01  
OQS  
ZDS:k  
k=0 HDD normal/event recording sector  
k=1 HDD copy sector  
k=2 Disk connected to COPY 1  
k=3 Disk connected to COPY 2)  
Marking  
ZMP  
ZMP  
Alarm Control  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Alarm input  
OAI:b1b2b3a1a2a3a4  
OAI  
b1b2b3: Head alarm CH information (binary)  
a1a2a3a4: Alarm CH information (binary)  
Alarm input with text  
ZAI:b1b2b3a1a2a3a4:  
nn:ddd ddd  
ZAI:nn  
b1b2b3: Head alarm CH information (binary)  
a1a2a3a4: Alarm CH information (binary)  
nn=01 - 99 (Sequence No)  
...  
...  
ddd ddd: text (200 bytes or less)  
Alarm reset  
OAL;n  
MAD:n  
OAL  
n=0 Alarm all reset  
n=1 Alarm reset  
n=0 Alarm suspension OFF  
n=1 Alarm suspension ON)  
n=0 LED OFF  
n=1 LED ON  
Alarm suspension  
MAD:n  
ALD:n  
Alarm change information  
(LED indication)  
n=2 LED Blinking  
Alarm change information  
ALM: b1b2b3a1a2a3a4  
b1b2b3: Head alarm CH information (binary)  
a1a2a3a4: Alarm CH information (binary)  
Setup Control  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Display SETUP MENU  
MSU:n  
MSU:n  
n=0 SETUP MENU OFF  
n=1 SETUP MENU ON  
Move cursor  
DCR:n1n2  
DCR  
n1n2=A1 Right  
n1n2=C1 Upward  
n1n2=E1 Left  
n1n2=G1 Downward  
n1n2=+1 Increment parameter (+)  
n1n2=-1 Decrement parameter ()  
n1n2=PD Move to virtual menu (SET)  
n1n2=P- Go back to an older page (BACK)  
n1n2=PU Move to upper layer (ESC)  
Date & Time setup  
Summer time setup  
Recording mode setup  
TSU:yyyymmddhhnn  
MST:n  
MRM:n  
TSU  
MST  
MRM  
yyyymmddhhnn: Date and time  
n=0 Standard time n=1 Summer time  
n=0 Normal recording mode  
n=2 Continuous (External timer) recording  
mode  
Login/Logout  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Login  
OLI:uuu...uuu:  
ppp ppp  
OLI:n  
uuu...uuu: User name (32-byte fixed length)  
ppp...ppp: Password (32-byte fixed length)  
n=0 Error in user name/password  
n=1 Login succeeded  
...  
n=2 Login failed  
Logout  
OLO  
OLO  
146  
Data Control  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Copy by specifying  
record  
ZCR:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr:m  
ZCR  
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record No.  
m=0 Copy to HDD copy sector  
m=1 Copy to media connected to COPY 1  
m=2 Copy to media connected to COPY 2  
Copy by specifying date ZCT:y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1  
ZCT  
y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1h1h1n1n1: Start date & time of  
data copy  
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2n2n2: End date & time of  
data copy  
& time  
h1h1n1n1:y2y2y2y2m2m2  
d2d2h2h2n2n2:s:ccc:m  
s=0 Format to specify the camera CH. Fixed to  
0
ccc: Camera CH No. of target for data copy  
m=0 Copy to HDD copy sector  
m=1 Copy to media connected to COPY 1  
m=2 Copy to media connected to COPY 2  
Data copy completed  
ZEC:y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1  
h1h1n1n1:  
y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1h1h1n1n1 Start date & time of  
data copy  
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2  
n2n2:s:ccc:m  
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2n2n2 End date & time of  
data copy  
s=0 Format to specify the camera CH. Fixed to  
0
ccc: Camera CH No. of target for data copy  
m=0 Copy to HDD copy sector  
m=1 Copy to media connected to COPY 1  
m=2 Copy to media connected to COPY 2  
Cancel data copy  
Erase log  
ZDC  
ZLC:k  
ZDC  
ZLC:k  
k=1 Event input log  
k=2 Trouble log  
k=3 Access log  
Log data total number  
inquiry  
ZLQ:k:y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1  
h1h1n1n1:y2y2y2y2m2m2  
d2d2h2h2n2n2  
ZLQ:k:y1y1y1y1m1m1  
d1d1h1h1n1n1  
y2y2y2y2m2m2  
k=0 Record list  
k=1 Event input log  
k=2 Trouble log  
d2d2h2h2n2n2:dddddddd  
k=3 (Access log)  
y1y1y1y1m1m1d1d1h1h1n1n1: Start date & time of  
inquiry range  
y2y2y2y2m2m2d2d2h2h2n2n2: End date & time of  
inquiry range  
dddddddd: Log data total number  
Log readout  
ZLR:yyyymmdd  
hhnn:mmmmmmmm  
ZLR:k:<Log Data  
1>s1:<Log Data  
2>s2: :<Log Data  
k=1 (Event input log)  
k=2 (Trouble log)  
k=3 (Access log)  
...  
n>sn  
yyyymmddhhnn Start date & time of readout  
logs  
mmmmmmmm: Total number of acquired logs  
(00000000 - 00000050)  
<Log Data n>: Log data  
sn: 0-9 Cyclic number  
Record list acquisition  
ZGR:yyyymmddnn  
:nnnnnnnn  
ZGR<Log Data  
1>s1:<Log Data  
2>s2: :<Log Data n>sn  
yyyymmddhhnn: Start date & time of readout  
list  
mmmmmmmm: Total record number in the  
acquired list (00000001 - 00000050)  
<Log Data n>: Log data  
...  
sn: 0-9 Cyclic number  
Text acquisition  
Text writing  
ZGT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr  
ZGT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: <TEXT>  
ZPT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr  
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record No.  
<TEXT>: text data  
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record No.  
ZPT:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: <TEXT>  
<TEXT>: text data 200 bytes or less  
Disk End Notification  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Disk end auto-notification MDE:n  
setting  
MDE:n  
n=0 (Auto-notification OFF)  
n=1 (Auto-notification ON)  
Disk end auto-notification HDE:–  
HDE:p  
p=1 (Normal recording sector)  
p=2 (Event recording sector)  
p=3 (Copy sector)  
147  
Search Operation  
Item  
Display search editing  
area  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
ZTL:n ZTL:n  
Parameter (ASCII)  
n=0 (Search editing area OFF)  
n=1 (Recording event search list ON)  
n=2 (Recording event search thumbnail ON)  
n=3 (VMD search list ON)  
n=4 (VMD Search Thumbnail OFF)  
n=5 (Marking search list ON)  
n=6 (Marking search thumbnail ON)  
n=7 (Search playback display ON)  
Display Operation  
Item  
Switch display  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
DIN:n DIN  
Parameter (ASCII)  
n=+  
Inquiry  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Additional disk space  
inquiry  
QHR:p  
QHR:p:sss  
p=1 HDD normal recording sector  
p=2 HDD event recording sector  
p=3 HDD copy sector  
p=4 Disk connected to COPY 1  
p=5 Disk connected to COPY 2  
sss: Additional disk space (%)  
ID request  
QID  
QIB  
QIC  
QID:WJ-HD309  
or  
QID:WJ-HD316  
Interface ID request  
QIB:WJ-HD309  
or  
QIB:WJ-HD316  
Production category  
request  
QIC:2  
Alarm information request QLD:0  
QLD:n  
n=0 (No alarm)  
n=1 (Alarm end)  
n=2 (Under alarm operation)  
Software version inquiry  
Status inquiry  
QRV  
QSR  
QRV:n.nn  
QSR:Status 1:Status 2  
n.nn: Software version  
...  
Following response commands are sends back  
...  
for "Status 1:Status 2  
"
msu:0 Under normal operation  
msu:1 Under setting  
oms:0001 Monitor 1  
oms:0002 Monitor 2  
ocs:ccccc ccccc: Camera number  
otc:n Multiscreen segment display pattern  
n=0: 4 segments  
n=1: 7segments  
n=2: 9 segments  
n=3: 10 segments  
n=4: 13 segments  
n=5: 16 segments  
oqt: 01F Sequence activated  
ozm: 0 Zoom OFF  
ozm: 2 x2 zoom  
ozm: 4 x4 zoom  
mad: 0 Alarm suspension OFF  
mad: 1 Alarm suspension ON  
zcd: Cascade activated  
zqs: 1 CH recording activated:2 CH recording  
...  
activated 16 CH recording activated  
Recording status nn=00 (Recording stop)  
nn=01 (Manual recording activated)  
nn=02 (Event recording activated)  
nn=03 (Schedule recording activated)  
nn=04 (Emergency recording activated)  
148  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
zqm: Monitor status: camera CH: Playback  
time  
Monitor status n=0 Live  
n=1 Live sequence  
n=2 Playback  
n=3 Other statuses  
Camera CH  
Playback time: yyyymmddhhnnss  
ztl:n Search editing area ON  
n=0 Search editing area OFF  
n=1 Recording event search list ON  
n=2 Recording event search thumbnail  
ON  
n=3 VMD search list ON  
n=4 VMD search thumbnail ON  
n=5 Marking search list ON  
n=6 Marking search thumbnail ON  
n=7 Search playback display ON  
zdt:0 Text display OFF  
zdt:1 Text display ON  
Recording mode inquiry  
Monitor status inquiry  
QRM  
ZQM  
QRM:n  
n=0 Normal recording mode  
n=2 Continuous (External timer) recording  
mode  
ZQM:m:a1a2a3a4:yyyy  
mmddhhnnss  
m=0 Live  
m=1 Live sequence  
m=2 Playback  
m=3 Other statuses  
a1a2a3a4: Camera CH information (binary)  
yyyymmddhhnnss: Playback time  
Recording status inquiry  
ZQS  
ZQS:1 CH recording activated: Recording status nn=00 (Recording stop)  
...  
2 CH recording activated 16  
nn=01 (Manual recording activated)  
nn=02 (Event recording activated)  
nn=03 (Schedule recording activated)  
nn=04 (Emergency recording activated)  
CH recording activated  
Record number informa-  
tion  
ZRN:sss:nn:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr  
:nnyyyymmddhhnnss:  
ccc:x;yyy:t  
sss: Unit address  
nn=Sequence number  
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record number  
yyyymmddhhnnss: Recording event date and  
time  
ccc: Camera CH  
x=0 Manual recording  
x=1 Schedule recording  
x=2 VMD recording  
x=3 Alarm port recording  
x=4 Command alarm recording  
x=5 VIDEO LOSS recording  
x=6 Emergency recording  
yyy: Event-activated CH  
t=0 Text included  
t=1 Text not included  
nn=Sequence number  
Camera SYNC status  
inquiry  
QSY:a1a2a3a4a5  
:b1b2b3b4b5  
QSY:a1a2a3a4a5  
b1b2b3b4b5:s1s2s3 sm  
a1a2a3a4a5 - b1b2b3b4b5: Range of camera CH  
to inquire SYNC status  
s1s2s3 sm: SYNC status of each camera  
...  
...  
(sm=0: SYNC status not found  
sm=1: SYNC status found)  
149  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Record information  
inquiry  
ZGP:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr  
ZGP:rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr:  
ccc:q:nnnn:yyyymmdd  
hhnnss:nnss:t:ssssss  
rrrrrrrrrrrrrrrr: Record number  
ccc: Camera CH  
q: picture quality (0 (Very Fine), 1 (Fine), 2  
(Normal), 3 (Extended))  
nnnn: Recording rate  
yyyymmddhhnnss: Recording start date and  
time  
nnss: Recording total time  
t=0 Text included  
t=1 Text not included  
ssssss: Record size [KB]  
Communication  
Item  
Transmission command (ASCII) Response command (ASCII)  
RCK RCK  
Parameter (ASCII)  
Communication check  
150  
FLOWCHART OF THE SETUP MENU  
Maintenance  
REC Rate  
Recording  
REC Setup  
Event  
Event Setup  
Schedule  
Time Table  
Event Setup  
VMD  
Maintenance  
Disk Info  
Recording  
Emergency REC  
Schedule  
REC PROGRAM  
Event Setup  
Video Loss  
REC PROGRAM  
Recording Program  
Maintenance  
Version info  
Schedule  
EVENT PROGRAM  
Event Setup  
Terminal/Command  
Alarm  
EVENT PROGRAM  
Event Program  
Event  
VMD Setup  
Event Program  
VMD  
Maintenance  
Disk End Mode  
VMD Area Setup  
For each camera  
Event Program  
Video Loss  
Event  
Alarm Setup  
Maintenance  
Disk Capacity  
Event Program  
Terminal/Command  
Alarm  
Event  
Terminal Setup  
Maintenance  
Disk Delete  
Schedule  
Special Days  
Maintenance  
Event Log  
Maintenance  
Error Log  
Maintenance  
Access Log  
Maintenance  
Monitor 1  
Display  
OSD Setup  
Comm  
Camera Control  
System  
Basic Setup  
OSD Setup  
Monitor 1  
Camera Title  
Live Sequence  
Maintenance  
Monitor 2  
Display  
Monitor 1  
Comm  
PS·Data Setup  
System  
Time & Date  
Monitor 2  
PS·Data Setup  
Time & Date  
Live Sequence  
Camera Number Setup  
Summer Time  
(Day Light Saving)  
Table  
Display  
Monitor 2  
Comm  
RS485 Setup  
System  
User Regist.  
RS485 Setup  
Control Camera CH  
Comm  
System  
RS232 Setup  
User Edit  
Comm  
System  
NW Setup 1  
User Delete  
Comm  
System  
NW Setup 2  
Host Regist.  
Comm  
System  
NTP Setup  
Host Edit  
System  
Host Delete  
System  
User Level  
System  
Save/Load  
151  
PARAMETERS AND THE DEFAULT SETTINGS OF THE SETUP MENU  
These are the setting parameters and the default settings of the items on the SETUP MENU.  
Refer to these as reference.  
Setup Menu  
Setup Item  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Maintenance  
Disk Info  
Warning for Disk Life Time  
HDD Safety Mode  
Normal Recording Area  
Event Recording Area  
Copy Area  
10 000 h/20 000 h/30 000 h  
ON/OFF  
20 000 h  
OFF  
Disk End Mode  
Disk Capacity  
Data Delete  
CONTINUE/STOP  
CONTINUE/STOP  
CONTINUE/STOP  
CONTINUE/STOP  
CONTINUE/STOP  
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %  
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %  
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %  
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %  
OFF/1 %/2 %/···/10 %  
CONTINUE  
CONTINUE  
STOP  
COPY1  
STOP  
COPY2  
STOP  
Normal Recording Area  
Event Recording Area  
Copy Area  
10 %  
10 %  
10 %  
COPY1  
10 %  
COPY2  
10 %  
Auto Delete  
OFF/1DAY/2DAYS/···.../10DAYS/14DAYS/  
30DAYS/45DAYS/60DAYS/90DAYS/  
120DAYS/150DAYS/180DAYS  
OFF  
Recording  
REC Setup  
Recording  
ON/OFF  
ON  
Power ON Manual REC  
Manual Recording Channel  
Color Mode  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
MON2/ALL  
ALL  
COLOR FINE/COLOR STD/B/W  
ON/OFF  
COLOR STD  
Embedded REC(Title)  
ON  
ON  
Embedded REC(Time & Date) ON/OFF  
REC Priority  
Manual REC/Schedule REC/Event REC  
1: Event REC  
2: Manual REC  
3: Schedule REC  
Audio Allocation  
HD316: OFF/CAM1/CAM2.....CAM16  
HD309: OFF/CAM1/.....CAM9  
AUDIO1 to 4: OFF  
FIELD  
Emergency REC  
Resolution  
FRAME 3D ON/FRAME 3D OFF/FIELD/SIF  
Recording Time  
1 s/2 s/..../10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m/..../10 m/  
20 m/30 m/40 m/50 m/60 m/MANUAL/  
CONTINUE  
10 s  
Recording Rate and Quality  
Recording rate: 1 ips/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/  
6.3 ips/8.3 ips/12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips  
Quality: SFA/SFB/FQA/FQB/NQA/NQB/  
EXA/EXB  
2.5 ips  
SFB  
OFF  
Auto Copy  
OFF/ON  
Event  
Event Setup  
Alarm Output  
OFF/1 s/2 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/  
2 m/...../5 m/EXT  
VMD: OFF  
Video Loss: 2 s  
Terminal Command Alarm: 2 s  
Output Terminal  
HD316: TRM1/TRM2/...../TRM16  
HD309: TRM1/TRM2/...../TRM9  
152  
Setup Menu  
Setup Item  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Event Setup  
Buzzer  
OFF/1 s/2 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/  
2 m/...../5 m/EXT  
VMD: OFF  
Video Loss: 2 s  
Terminal Command Alarm: 2 s  
Monitor1 Action  
Monitor2 Action  
HD316: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM16  
HD309: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM9  
VMD: OFF  
Video Loss: Camera channel with a video  
loss occurrence  
Terminal Command Alarm: Same number  
for camera channel number and alarm  
number  
HD316: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM16  
HD309: OFF/CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM9  
VMD: OFF  
Video Loss: Camera channel with a video  
loss occurrence  
Terminal Command Alarm: Same number  
for camera channel number and alarm  
number  
VMD Setup  
(SETUP AREA)  
(SETUP ALL AREA)  
(DELETE AREA)  
(DELETE ALL AREA)  
(SENSITIVITY)  
(VMD MODE)  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(EXIT)  
-
Alarm Setup  
Alarm Auto Reset  
OFF/1 s/2 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/  
4 m/5 m  
OFF  
Alarm Disarm Time  
Terminal Setup  
2 s/3 s/...../10 s  
2 s  
Terminal Setup  
N.O./N.C.  
N.O.  
Schedule  
Time Table  
Period  
12:00AM to 12:00AM  
12:00AM to 12:00AM (Everyday/Time  
zone1)  
--:-- to --:-- (Except above)  
REC PROGRAM  
PROG1/PROG2/PROG3/PROG4  
PROG1/PROG2/PROG3/PROG4  
ON/OFF  
PROG1  
PROG1  
OFF  
EVENT PROGRAM  
FTP SEND BY PERIODIC  
TIMER  
ERROR REPORT MAIL  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
WARNING REPORT MAIL  
NW BANDWIDTH CONTROL  
OFF/32kbps/64kbps/128kbps/256kbps/  
512kbps/1024kbps/2Mbps/5Mbps/10Mbps  
Resolution  
RATE  
FRAME 3D ON/FRAME 3D OFF/FIELD/FRAME  
FIELD  
REC PROGRAM  
OFF/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/8.3 ips/ Manual REC: 12.5 ips  
12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips/100 ips  
Schedule REC: 12.5 ips  
Event REC: 25 ips  
RATE  
OFF/AUTO/0.1 ips/0.2 ips/0.3 ips/0.4 ips/  
0.5 ips/1 ips/1.7 ips/2.5 ips/4.2 ips/5 ips/6.3 ips/ SCHEDULE: AUTO  
MANUAL: AUTO  
8.3 ips/12.5 ips/25 ips/50 ips  
EVENT (PRE): 1 ips  
EVENT (POST): 1 ips  
QUALITY  
SFA/SFB/FQA/FQB/NQA/NQB/EXA/EXB  
FQB  
DURATION (TIME for the unit) 1 s/2 s/...../10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m,/...../  
10 m/20 m/...../60 m/MANUAL/CONTINUE  
EVENT (PRE): 10 s  
EVENT (POST): 30 s  
EVENT PROGRAM Action Mode (The unit)  
ALARM/ACT DET  
Video Loss, Terminal/Command Alarm:  
ALARM  
VMD: ACT DET  
REC CH  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
--/1/2/...../64  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
--  
Auto Copy  
Preset Position  
Serial Notice  
Mail Notice  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
FTP Alarm Sending  
153  
Setup Menu  
Setup Item  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Special Days  
DATE  
Mode  
1/1 to 12/31  
--  
--  
MON/TUE/WED/THU/FRI/SAT/SUN  
Switcher  
Monitor1  
Live Sequence  
[Operating with the buttons of the unit]  
WJ-HD316:  
1/2/.../16/1-4/5-8/9-12/13-16/1-9/10-16/--  
WJ-HD309:  
HD316: STEP1: CAM1,  
STEP2: CAM2, ...... STEP16: CAM16  
HD309: STEP1: CAM1,  
STEP2: CAM2, ...... STEP9:CAM9  
1/2/.../9/1-4/5-8/9-9/1-9/--  
[Operating via a network]  
WJ-HD316:  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/9SCREEN1-9/  
9SCREEN10-16/--  
WJ-HD309:  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9/9SCREEN/--  
--/1/2/.../64  
--  
1 s/2 s/.../30 s  
2 s  
Sequence Timing  
Auto Skip  
INT/EXT/MON2  
ON/OFF  
INT  
ON  
Login Screen  
WJ-HD316:  
16SCREEN  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/  
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/  
16SCREEN/SEQ/--  
WJ-HD309:  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ/--  
Secret View  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
Monitor2  
Live Sequence  
[Operating with the buttons of the unit]  
WJ-HD316:  
1/2/.../16/1-4/5-8/9-12/13-16/1-9/10-16/--  
WJ-HD309:  
HD316: STEP1: CAM1,  
STEP2: CAM2, .....STEP16:CAM16  
HD309: STEP1: CAM1,  
STEP2: CAM2, ..... STEP9:CAM9  
1/2/.../9/1-4/5-8/9-9/1-9/--  
[Operating via a network]  
WJ-HD316:  
CAM1/CAM2/...../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/9SCREEN1-9/  
9SCREEN10-16/--  
WJ-HD309:  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9/9SCREEN/--  
--/1/2/.../64  
--  
1 s/2 s/.../30 s  
2 s  
Sequence Timing  
Auto Skip  
INT/EXT  
ON/OFF  
INT  
ON  
Login Screen  
WJ-HD316:  
QUAD1-4  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/  
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/  
16SCREEN/SEQ/--  
WJ-HD309:  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ/--  
Display  
OSD Setup  
Time & Date Display Position  
Camera Title Display Position  
L-UPPER/R-UPPER/L-LOWER/R-LOWER  
L-UPPER  
R-LOWER  
L-UPPER/R-UPPER/L-LOWER/R-LOWER/  
CENTER  
Line Color on the Multi Screen WHITE/GRAY/BLACK  
WHITE  
154  
Setup Menu  
Setup Item  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Monitor1  
Time & Date Display  
Camera Title Display  
Alarm Display  
ON/OFF  
ON  
ON/OFF  
ON  
ON/OFF  
ON  
Monitor2  
Display Mode  
MODE1/MODE2/MODE3  
UPPER/LOWER  
MODE1  
LOWER  
T&D and Status Display  
Position  
Camera Title Display  
ON/OFF  
ON  
Comm  
Camera Control  
COMP  
TYPE  
S/M/L  
HD316: CAM1to CAM8: S  
HD309: CAM1 to CAM6: S  
HD316: CAM1 to CAM8: COAX/RS485/OFF,  
CAM9 to CAM12: RS485/PSD/OFF,  
CAM13 to CAM16: RS485/PSD/OFF  
HD309: CAM1 to CAM6: COAX/RS485/OFF,  
CAM7 to CAM9: RS485/PSD/OFF  
HD316: CAM1 to CAM8: COAX,  
CAM9 to CAM12: PSD,  
CAM13 to CAM16: PSD  
HD309: CAM1 to CAM6: COAX,  
CAM7 to CAM9: PSD  
PS·Data Setup  
Unit Address(System)  
Unit Address(Controller)  
Cascade  
001 to 099  
001  
001  
OFF  
9 600  
8
001 to 099  
ON/OFF  
Baud Rate  
2 400/4 800/9 600/19 200/38 400  
Data Bit  
8
Parity  
NONE/EVEN/ODD  
NONE  
1
Stop Bit  
1/2  
Retry Timing  
Alarm Data  
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1000 ms/  
OFF/0 s/1 s/5 s  
OFF  
1 s  
Camera Number Setup  
001 to 099  
HD316: 1: 001 to 16: 016  
HD309: 1: 001 to 9: 009  
RS485 Setup  
Baud Rate  
4 800/9 600/19 200  
PORT1/PORT2  
9 600  
Control Camera CH  
HD316: CAM1 to CAM8: PORT1,  
CAM9 to CAM16: PORT2  
HD309: CAM1 to CAM9: PORT1  
Data Bit  
8
8
Parity  
NONE  
NONE  
Stop Bit  
1
1
RS232C Setup  
NW Setup1  
NW Setup2  
Unit Address(System)  
Baud Rate  
Data Bit  
001 to 099  
001  
9 600/19 200/38 400  
9 600  
7/8  
8
Parity  
NONE/EVEN/ODD  
NONE  
Stop Bit  
1/2  
1
Retry Timing  
HTTP Port Number  
User Authentication  
Host Authentication  
Line Speed  
Live Video Quality  
Video Rate  
DHCP  
OFF/100 ms/200 ms/400 ms/1000 ms/  
OFF  
00000 to 65535  
00080  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
AUTO  
AUTO  
FQB  
FQB  
FAST/MIDDLE/SLOW/VERY SLOW  
ON/OFF  
MIDDLE  
OFF  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Gateway  
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255  
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255  
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255  
ON/OFF  
192.168.0.250  
255.255.255.000  
192.168.000.001  
OFF  
DNS  
Primary  
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255  
000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255  
ON/OFF  
000.000.000.000  
000.000.000.000  
OFF  
Secondary  
DDNS  
155  
Setup Menu  
Setup Item  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
NW Setup2  
User Name  
-
-
User Password  
Access Interval  
Host Name  
-
-
10 m/30 m/1 h/6 h/24 h  
-
1 h  
HD316: HD316  
HD309: HD309  
Domain Name  
COMMUNITY  
-
-
localdomain  
public  
Network SNMP  
Setup  
CONTACT  
-
-
SYSTEM NAME  
LOCATION  
-
-
-
-
NTP Setup  
Time Adjustment  
Time Zone  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
GMT-12:00/GMT-11:00/...../GMT-4:00/GMT-3:30/  
GMT-3:00/...../GMT-1:00/GMT 0:00/GMT+1:00/  
GMT+2:00/...../GMT+9:00/GMT+9:30/  
GMT+10:00/...../GMT+13:00  
GMT-0:00  
NTP Server Address  
Refresh Interval  
-
-
1 h/2 h/6 h/12 h/24 h  
6 h  
Network FTP Setup FTP Server Address  
User Name  
-
-
-
-
User Password  
Mode  
-
-
SEQUENTIAL/PASSIVE  
SEQUENTIAL  
Server Directory  
File Name  
-
-
TIME & DATE BASE/SERIAL NUMBER  
TIME & DATE BASE  
Interval  
-
01 s  
Channel to Send  
Server Directory  
File Name  
CAM1 to CAM16  
-
-
-
TIME & DATE BASE/SERIAL NUMBER  
TIME & DATE BASE  
Duration-Pre  
OFF/1 s/2 s/3 s/4 s/5 s/6 s/7 s/8 s/9 s/10 s  
OFF  
Duration-Post  
OFF/1 s/2 s/3 s/4 s/5 s/6 s/7 s/8 s/9 s/10 s  
5 s  
Network Mail Setup Attach Alarm Image  
Mail Server Address  
Send to  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
-
-
-
-
Address1  
-
-
From Address  
-
-
POP before SMTP  
POP Server Address  
User Name  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
-
-
-
-
-
-
User Password  
System  
Basic Setup  
ADMIN Password  
PSD User  
-
12345  
-
ADMIN  
Auto Login  
ON/OFF  
ON  
Auto Login User  
Auto Logout  
Priority  
-
ADMIN  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
Follow the priority./Pre-priority/Post-priority  
5 s/10 s/30 s/1 m/5 m  
Follow the priority.  
5 s  
"GO TO LAST" before  
Language  
JAPANESE/ENGLISH/FRANÇAIS/ESPAÑOL/  
DEUTSCH/ITALIANO  
ENGLISH  
OFF  
Beep (Operation)  
Buzzer (Error)  
Shutdown Time  
Auto Copy  
ON/OFF  
OFF/1 s/...../30 s/40 s/50 s/1 m/...../5 m/EXT  
10 s/20 s/30 s/1 m/2 m/3 m/4 m/5 m  
ON/OFF  
2 s  
10 s  
OFF  
156  
Setup Menu  
Setup Item  
Parameter  
Default Setting  
Time & Date  
Date Format  
Time Format  
Auto Adjust Time  
Master Time  
YY.MM.DD/MMM.DD.YY/DD.MMM.YY  
24 h/12 h  
DD.MMM.YY  
12 h  
ON/OFF  
OFF  
0:00/1:00/...../23:00  
0:00  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving) ON/OFF/AUTO  
Summer Time(Day Light Saving)  
OFF  
Table  
-
-
-
User Regist.  
User Edit  
User Name  
Password  
Level  
-
-
-
User Delete  
1/2/3  
1/2/...../16  
1
1
Priority  
Default Screen  
WJ-HD316  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/  
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/  
16SCREEN/SEQ  
WJ-HD309  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ  
CAM1  
Camera Partitioning  
Host IP Address  
Level  
--/View/View/Operate  
View/Operate  
Host Regist.  
Host Edit  
-
-
1
1
1/2/3  
Host Delete  
Priority  
1/2/...../16  
Default Screen  
WJ-HD316  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM16/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9-12/QUAD13-16/7SCREEN/9SCREEN1-9/  
9SCREEN10-16/10SCREEN/13SCREEN/  
16SCREEN/SEQ  
WJ-HD309  
CAM1/CAM2/.../CAM9/QUAD1-4/QUAD5-8/  
QUAD9/7SCREEN/9SCREEN/SEQ  
CAM1  
Camera Partitioning  
WJ-HD300 Setup  
WJ-HD300 Setup Status  
Camera Setup  
--/View/View/Operate  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
View/Operate  
LV1  
User Level  
LV1,LV2  
LV1  
Event Log Status  
Access Log Status  
Error Log Status  
LV1,LV2  
LV1,LV2  
LV1,LV2  
LV1,LV2  
LV1  
Alarm Reset  
Alarm Suspended Time  
Copy  
LV1  
Normal Recording Erase  
Event Recording Erase  
Manual REC Operation  
Playback Operation  
N/W Access  
LV1  
LV1  
LV1,LV2  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
LV1,LV2,LV3  
157  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
Check the following before requesting repair.  
Contact your dealer if a problem cannot be solved even after checking and trying the solution or a problem is not described  
below, and when having a problem with installations.  
Check item/Remedy  
Page  
Problem  
Check if the power plug is properly connected to the AC  
outlet.  
Power is not turned on.  
Check if the power cord is properly inserted into the power  
socket of the unit.  
The HDD SAFETY MODE win-  
dow is displayed after turning  
on the power of the unit.  
The HDD SAFETY MODE is set to ON.  
In this case, set the HDD SAFETY MODE to OFF.  
Refer to p. 68.  
Check if the lens covers of the cameras have been  
removed.  
Check if the power is supplied to cameras and connected  
devices.  
No camera image is displayed  
on MON 1, MON 2, and the  
VGA monitor  
Refer to p. 70.  
Check if the cable connections are correct.  
Check the brightness and contrast settings of the moni-  
tors.  
Refer to p. 123  
and 125.  
Can the users display camera images on the monitors?  
Check the level settings of the users logging in.  
The log-in menu does not  
appear even if you press the  
button of the unit.  
Check if any user has logged in with the system controller.  
The camera image is dim.  
Check if dust may be sticking to the camera lens.  
Can the users display the SETUP MENU on the monitors?  
Check the level settings of the users logging in.  
Refer to p. 123  
and 125.  
Cannot open SETUP MENU.  
Check if monitor 1 is used to display the SETUP MENU.  
The SETUP MENU cannot be displayed on monitor 1.  
Refer to page  
10.  
158  
Check item/Remedy  
Page  
Problem  
Check if the HDD has any available disk space.  
Refer to p. 95.  
Check if the recording setup is set to ON.  
Check the schedule settings.  
Refer to p. 98.  
Refer to p. 105.  
Refer to p. 98.  
Cannot start recording.  
Check the recording priority settings.  
When the setting menu is displayed by a non-interlace  
signal, the setting menu may be unable to function nor-  
mally.  
Since the setting menu of the matrix switcher is displayed  
by a non-interlace signal, recording or displaying with this  
unit may be impossible.  
Cannot record the SETUP  
MENU of a matrix switcher  
Refer to p. 28.  
Check if images have been recorded on the HDD.  
Refer to p. 123  
and 125.  
Can the users record images?  
Check the level settings of the users logging in.  
Cannot playback images.  
Can the users display camera images on the monitors?  
Check the level settings of the users logging in.  
Refer to p. 123  
and 125.  
Check the connection of the camera you are going to con-  
trol. Coaxial communication control is available for cam-  
eras connected to VIDEO IN 1 to 8 for the WJ-HD316 (1  
to 6 for the WJ-HD309).  
Refer to p. 70.  
Check if the camera you are going to control is a combina-  
tion camera.  
Refer to p. 70.  
Refer to p. 116.  
Cannot control cameras.  
Check the camera control settings.  
Refer to p. 123  
and 125.  
Can the users control the cameras?  
Check the level settings of the users logging in.  
Check the BUSY indicator. When the indicator is lighting,  
a higher-priority user is controlling the cameras. You can-  
not control the cameras until the indicator goes out.  
Refer to p. 8.  
159  
Check item/Remedy  
Page  
Problem  
Check if alarm input signals are properly input to the  
ALARM or ALARM/CONTROL at the rear panel.  
Refer to p. 83  
and 87.  
Alarm operations are not acti-  
vated.  
Refer to p. 87.  
Refer to p. 107.  
Check the settings of the ALARM connector.  
Check if the operation mode is set to ALARM (alarm  
mode).  
Check the camera connections.  
Refer to p. 70.  
"VIDEO LOSS" appears on the  
monitor.  
If the camera connections are proper, refer to the dealer.  
Cable wires may be snapped or the unit may have some  
trouble.  
Check if the ambient operating temperature is between  
+5°C and +45 °C (41 °F - 113 °F).  
When the inside of unit exceeds 45 °C (113 °F), "THER-  
MAL" may appear even within the ambient temperature  
mentioned above.  
Refer to p. 5  
and 14.  
"THERMAL" appears on the  
monitor.  
If "THERMAL" frequently appear on monitors, refer to the  
dealer. The unit may have some trouble.  
Check if the built-in backup battery has been charged  
enough. If not so, supply power to the unit for 48 hours or  
more to recharge the battery.  
Refer to p. 5.  
Refer to p. 5.  
The clock does not keep cor-  
rect time.  
Check if the built-in backup battery has been worn out.  
The battery life is approx. 5 years. (The battery lifetime  
may differ depending on the condition of the environ-  
ment.)  
Check if HDDs were added or removed. If so, the HDD  
DISK MENU will be displayed automatically.  
Refer to p. 131.  
When you turn on the power of  
the unit, the HDD DISK MENU  
is displayed.  
If the HDD DISK MENU is displayed even though no  
HDDs were added or removed, refer to the dealer. The  
HDD may have some trouble.  
160  
Check item/Remedy  
Page  
Problem  
Check if "Disk End Mode" is set to STOP.  
Refer to p. 95.  
The additional disk space of  
HDD is not displayed.  
Check if there is a partition in the HDD.  
Check if the "Disk End Mode" is set to STOP.  
Refer to p. 95.  
The available disk space of  
HDD is not displayed on the  
right bar.  
Check if there is a partition in the HDD.  
Refer to the Net-  
work Setup In-  
Check the network settings of the unit and PC.  
structions (PDF).  
Cannot establish a connection  
via the network.  
Check the host registration setting. When host authentica-  
tion is set to ON, you cannot establish the connection  
from computers other than the PC registered as the host.  
Refer to p. 119  
and 124.  
Response or Image update  
takes time.  
Check if the network is crowded.  
When the unit fails to find all of the connected extension units  
(WJ-HDE300 series) previously mounted for the following rea-  
sons, it may take time to start up because the unit will be  
restarted while displaying the splash startup screen. They are  
normal operations.  
Rebooting of the unit occurs  
while displaying the splash  
startup screen.  
When dedicated cables connecting the unit and the extension  
units are not firmly connected or detached  
When all of the extension units previously mounted are  
disconnected  
Inspect the power cord, power plug and connectors periodically.  
The power cord insulation is  
damaged.  
The power cord, plug and connectors are worn out. This may result in electric  
shock or a fire. Unplug the power plug from the AC outlet immediately, and  
refer to qualified service personnel.  
The power cord, plug and con-  
nectors get hot during use.  
The power cord gets hot when  
bent or stretched.  
161  
SPECIFICATION  
General  
Power source:  
220 V - 240 V AC, 50 Hz  
85 W  
Power consumption  
Ambient operating  
temperature  
+5°C to +45°C (41 °F - 113 °F)  
Ambient operating  
humidity  
Less than 85 %  
Dimensions  
420 mm (W) X 88 mm (H) X 350 mm (D) [16-9/16" (W) X 3-7/16" (H) X  
13-3/4" (D)] (excluding rubber feet and projections)  
Weight  
9.5 kg (21 lbs.)  
Input/Output  
Video  
Video input connectors  
1 V [P-P] / 75 , with auto termination loop-thru, vertical timing pulse mul-  
tiplexed, x8 (1 to 8 CH) (BNC)  
1 V [P-P] / 75 , with auto-termination loop-thru,  
x8 (9 to 16 CH) (BNC)  
Cascade input connector 1 V [P-P] / 75 (BNC)  
Video output connectors 1 V [P-P] / 75 , active loop-thru output, x8 (1 to 8 CH) (BNC)*  
1 V [P-P] / 75 , active loop-thru output, x8 (9 to 16 CH) (BNC)  
1
Monitor output connectors 1 V [P-P] / 75 , x2 (BNC)  
Monitor output connector RGB output, x1 (15-pin D-sub)  
(VGA)  
S-video output connector Y = 1 V [P-P] / 75 , C=0.286 V [P-P] / 75 , x1 (S-video output connec-  
tor)  
Video output connector  
(front panel)  
1 V [P-P] / 75 , x1 (RCA pin)  
Audio  
Audio input connectors  
Audio output connectors  
Expansion connector  
Copy connectors  
10 dB, 10 K, x4 (RCA pin)  
10 dB, 600 , unbalanced, x2 (RCA pin)  
Others  
High-speed serial interface, 480 Mbps (theoretical value), x1  
High-speed serial interface, 480 Mbps (theoretical value), x2  
Control connectors  
Emergency recording input*2, additional space warning output*3 (for  
devices connected to copy connectors), HDD trouble output*3, camera  
trouble output*3, trouble output*3, electricity failure recovery completion  
output*4, time adjust input/output*5, sequence switching input/output*5,  
electricity failure detection input*2, external recording mode switching*2  
(25-pin D-sub) , +5 V output *7  
Alarm port  
1 to 8 CH alarm input*6, 1 to 16 CH alarm input*2, 1 to 16 alarm output*3,  
alarm recovery input*2, alarm suspension input*5 (25-pin D-sub)  
RS-485 ports  
DATA ports  
RS-485 (full duplex/half duplex*8), x2 (RJ-11)  
RS-485, x2 (RJ-11)  
SERIAL connector  
Ethernet port  
RS-232C, x1 (9-pin D-sub)  
10 Base-T/100 Base-Tx (RJ-45)  
1
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
When power is not supplied, the video output signal was not sent from the unit even if a video input signal is supplied.  
Non-voltage N.O. Contact, 100 mA, +5 V pull-up  
Open collector output, maximum under conditions of 24 V DC and 100 mA or less  
High (+12 V, 6.3 mA)  
30 K, 5 V pull-up, 100 mA, N.O. Contact  
5 V pull-up, 100 mA, Non-voltage N.O. Contact input  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
200 mA at maximum  
Changeable with the mode switch  
162  
STANDARD ACCESSORIES  
CD-ROM* ............................................................................ 1  
Operating Instructions (this manual) .................................. 1  
The following are for installation:  
Power Cord ......................................................................... 2  
Rack Mounting Bracket ...................................................... 2  
Screw for Rack Mounting Bracket ...................................... 4  
Cable Clamp ....................................................................... 1  
Screw for Cable Clamp ...................................................... 1  
Hard Disk Drive Fixing Screw ............................................. 4  
*The following are included on the CD-ROM:  
Viewer software  
Plug-in software  
Network Operating Instructions (PDF)  
Network Setup Operations (PDF)  
163  
Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd.  
Osaka, Japan  
http://www.panasonic.co.jp/global/  
2004 © Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. All rights reserved.  
NM0104-2034  
3TR001707CAA  
Printed in Japan  

Intel DDR266 PC2100 User Manual
Jenn Air CCG2523 User Manual
JVC LCT2142 001A H User Manual
KitchenAid KECC507KBL03 User Manual
LG Electronics 47WV30BS User Manual
LG Electronics W2242T User Manual
National Instruments Computer Hardware 321372C 01 User Manual
Panasonic Cordless Telephone KX TG1312BX User Manual
Philips 24CE3276 User Manual
Philips 109F52 User Manual